More NEWS copyedits, and some reordering
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blob4ec0e29f67c74849e5da35583be801093fae3144
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
277 #include "lisp.h"
278 #include "atimer.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
315 #include "font.h"
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
336 /* Cursor shapes. */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
339 /* Pointer shapes. */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
350 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_internal;
352 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
354 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
356 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
358 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
360 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
361 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
362 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
363 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
364 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
365 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
366 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
367 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
369 /* These setters are used only in this file, so they can be private. */
370 static void
371 wset_base_line_number (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
373 w->base_line_number = val;
375 static void
376 wset_base_line_pos (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
378 w->base_line_pos = val;
380 static void
381 wset_column_number_displayed (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
383 w->column_number_displayed = val;
385 static void
386 wset_region_showing (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
388 w->region_showing = val;
391 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
393 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
394 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
396 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
397 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
398 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
399 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
400 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
401 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
402 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
403 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
405 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
406 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
407 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
409 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
410 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
411 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
413 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
414 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
415 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
416 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
417 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
418 || (it->s \
419 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
420 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
421 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
422 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
423 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
425 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
427 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
429 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
431 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
433 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
435 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
437 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
438 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
440 Lisp_Object Qimage;
442 /* The image map types. */
443 Lisp_Object QCmap;
444 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
445 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
447 /* Tool bar styles */
448 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
450 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
451 message. */
453 int noninteractive_need_newline;
455 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
457 static int message_log_need_newline;
459 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
460 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
461 in handling memory-full errors. */
462 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
463 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
464 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
466 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
467 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
468 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
469 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
471 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
473 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
474 terminating newline. */
476 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
478 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
480 static int this_line_vpos;
481 static int this_line_y;
482 static int this_line_pixel_height;
484 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
485 negative if first character is partially visible. */
487 static int this_line_start_x;
489 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
490 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
491 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
493 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
495 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
497 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
500 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
501 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
502 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
503 numerical position. */
505 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
507 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
508 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
510 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
512 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
514 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
516 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
518 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected window (or
519 another buffer with the same base buffer). keyboard.c refers to
520 this. */
522 int buffer_shared;
524 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
526 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
528 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
529 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
530 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
532 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
534 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
535 pushes the current message and the value of
536 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
537 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
539 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
541 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
542 message was specified. */
544 static int message_enable_multibyte;
546 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
548 int update_mode_lines;
550 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
551 redisplay that finished. */
553 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
555 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
557 int cursor_type_changed;
559 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
560 line number. */
562 static int line_number_displayed;
564 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
566 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
568 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
569 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
571 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
573 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
575 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
577 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
579 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
581 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
582 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
584 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
586 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
587 message. */
589 static int message_buf_print;
591 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
593 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
594 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
596 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
597 of an emptied echo area. */
599 static int message_cleared_p;
601 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
602 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
604 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
605 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
606 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
608 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
610 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
612 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
614 int help_echo_showing_p;
616 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
617 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
618 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
620 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
622 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
623 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
624 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
625 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
626 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
628 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
630 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
631 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
632 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
633 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
634 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
635 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
636 return to the original iterator. */
637 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
638 do { \
639 if (CACHE) \
640 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
641 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
642 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
643 } while (0)
645 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
646 do { \
647 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
648 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
649 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
650 CACHE = NULL; \
651 } while (0)
653 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
655 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
656 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
658 int trace_redisplay_p;
660 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
662 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
663 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
664 int trace_move;
666 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
667 #else
668 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
669 #endif
671 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
673 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
675 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
677 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
679 enum prop_handled
681 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
682 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
683 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
684 HANDLED_RETURN
687 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
688 in. */
690 struct props
692 /* The name of the property. */
693 Lisp_Object *name;
695 /* A unique index for the property. */
696 enum prop_idx idx;
698 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
699 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
700 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
703 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
704 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
705 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
706 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
707 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
708 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
710 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
712 static struct props it_props[] =
714 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
715 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
716 `display' need to know the face. */
717 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
718 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
719 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
720 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
721 {NULL, 0, NULL}
724 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
725 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
727 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
729 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
731 enum move_it_result
733 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
734 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
736 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
737 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
739 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
740 MOVE_X_REACHED,
742 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
743 continued. */
744 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
746 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
747 be displayed truncated. */
748 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
750 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
751 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
754 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
755 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
756 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
757 cleared. */
759 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
760 static int clear_face_cache_count;
762 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
764 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
765 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
766 static int clear_image_cache_count;
768 /* Null glyph slice */
769 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
770 #endif
772 /* True while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
774 bool redisplaying_p;
776 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
777 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
779 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
780 (The display is done in read_char.) */
782 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
783 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
784 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
785 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
787 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
789 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
791 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
793 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
794 int hourglass_shown_p;
796 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
797 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
798 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
800 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
801 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
803 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
804 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
806 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
807 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
809 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
810 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
812 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
813 cursor. */
814 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
817 /* Function prototypes. */
819 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
820 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
821 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
822 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
823 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
824 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
825 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
826 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
828 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
830 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
832 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
833 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
834 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
835 struct text_pos);
836 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
837 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
838 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
839 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
840 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
841 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
842 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
843 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
844 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
845 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
846 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
847 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
848 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
849 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
850 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
851 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
852 static void pop_message (void);
853 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
854 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, int);
855 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
856 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
857 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
858 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
859 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
860 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
861 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
862 struct text_pos);
863 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
864 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
865 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
866 Lisp_Object);
867 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
868 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
869 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
870 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
871 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
872 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
873 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
874 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
875 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
876 static void pop_it (struct it *);
877 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
878 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
879 static void redisplay_internal (void);
880 static int echo_area_display (int);
881 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
882 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
883 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
884 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
885 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
886 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
887 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
888 int, int);
889 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
890 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
891 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
892 static int display_line (struct it *);
893 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
894 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
895 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
896 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
897 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
898 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
899 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
900 ptrdiff_t *);
901 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
902 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
903 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
904 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
905 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
906 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
907 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
908 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
909 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
910 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
911 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
912 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
913 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
914 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
915 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
916 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
917 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
918 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
919 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
920 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
921 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
922 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
923 struct display_pos *);
924 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
925 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
926 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
927 static enum move_it_result
928 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
929 enum move_operation_enum);
930 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
931 static void get_visually_first_element (struct it *);
932 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
933 struct glyph_row *);
934 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
935 struct glyph_row *);
936 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
937 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
938 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
939 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
940 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
941 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, int);
942 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, int);
943 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
944 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
945 Lisp_Object);
946 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
947 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
948 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
949 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
950 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
951 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
952 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
953 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
954 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
955 struct window *);
957 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
958 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
960 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
962 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
963 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
964 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
965 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
966 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
967 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
968 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
969 enum glyph_row_area,
970 int, int, int, int);
971 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
972 int, int, int);
975 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
977 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
978 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
979 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
983 /***********************************************************************
984 Window display dimensions
985 ***********************************************************************/
987 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
988 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
989 It is relative to the top of the window.
991 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
994 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
996 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
998 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
999 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1000 return height;
1003 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
1004 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
1005 the left and right of the window. */
1008 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
1010 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
1011 int pixels = 0;
1013 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1015 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
1017 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1019 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
1020 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
1021 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
1022 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
1023 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1025 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1027 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
1028 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
1029 pixels = 0;
1031 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1033 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
1034 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
1035 pixels = 0;
1039 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1043 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1044 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1047 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1049 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1050 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1052 eassert (height >= 0);
1054 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1055 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1056 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1057 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1058 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1060 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1062 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1063 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1064 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1065 : 0);
1066 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1067 height -= ml_row->height;
1068 else
1069 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1072 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1074 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1075 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1076 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1077 : 0);
1078 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1079 height -= hl_row->height;
1080 else
1081 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1084 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1085 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1086 return max (0, height);
1089 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1090 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1091 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1094 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1096 int x;
1098 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1099 return 0;
1101 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1103 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1104 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1105 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1106 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1107 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1108 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1109 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1110 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1112 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1113 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1114 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1115 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1117 return x;
1121 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1122 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1123 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1126 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1128 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1131 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1132 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1133 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1136 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1138 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1139 int x;
1141 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1142 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1144 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1145 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1147 return x;
1151 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1152 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1153 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1156 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1158 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1161 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1162 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1163 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1164 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1165 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1166 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1168 void
1169 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1170 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1172 if (box_width)
1173 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1174 if (box_height)
1175 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1176 if (box_x)
1177 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1178 if (box_y)
1180 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1181 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1182 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1187 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1188 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1189 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1190 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1191 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1192 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1193 box. */
1195 static void
1196 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1197 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1199 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1200 bottom_right_y);
1201 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1202 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1207 /***********************************************************************
1208 Utilities
1209 ***********************************************************************/
1211 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1212 This can modify IT's settings. */
1215 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1217 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1218 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1220 if (line_height == 0)
1222 if (last_height)
1223 line_height = last_height;
1224 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1226 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1227 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1228 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1229 : last_height);
1231 else
1233 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1235 /* Use the default character height. */
1236 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1237 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1238 it->c = ' ';
1239 it->len = 1;
1240 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1241 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1242 it->glyph_row = row;
1246 return line_top_y + line_height;
1249 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1250 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1251 static Lisp_Object
1252 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1254 if (CONSP (spec))
1256 while (CONSP (spec))
1258 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1259 return XCAR (spec);
1260 spec = XCDR (spec);
1263 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1265 ptrdiff_t i;
1267 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1269 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1270 return AREF (spec, i);
1272 return Qnil;
1275 return spec;
1279 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1280 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1281 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1282 static int
1283 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1285 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1286 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1287 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1289 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1290 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1292 return window_hscroll;
1295 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1296 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1297 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1298 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1299 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1302 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1303 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1305 struct it it;
1306 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1307 struct text_pos top;
1308 int visible_p = 0;
1309 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1311 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1312 return visible_p;
1314 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1316 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1317 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1320 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1321 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1322 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1323 our backs. */
1324 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1325 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1327 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1328 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1329 current_mode_line_height
1330 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1331 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1333 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1334 current_header_line_height
1335 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1336 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1338 start_display (&it, w, top);
1339 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1340 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1342 if (charpos >= 0
1343 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1344 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1345 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1346 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1347 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1348 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1349 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1351 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1352 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1353 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1354 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1355 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1356 glyph. */
1357 int top_x = it.current_x;
1358 int top_y = it.current_y;
1359 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1360 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1361 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1362 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1364 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1365 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1366 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1367 visible_p = 1;
1368 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1369 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1370 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1372 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1373 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1374 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1375 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1376 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1377 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1378 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1379 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1380 struct it save_it = it;
1381 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1382 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1383 int ten_more_lines =
1384 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)));
1386 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1387 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1388 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1389 visible_p = 0;
1391 it = save_it;
1393 if (visible_p)
1395 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1397 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1398 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1399 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1400 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1401 else
1403 struct it it2;
1404 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1405 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1406 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1407 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1408 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1409 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1410 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1411 else
1413 top_x = it2.current_x;
1414 top_y = it2.current_y;
1418 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1420 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1421 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1422 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1423 int newline_in_string = 0;
1425 if (STRINGP (string))
1427 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1428 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1429 while (s < e)
1431 if (*s++ == '\n')
1433 newline_in_string = 1;
1434 break;
1438 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1439 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1440 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1441 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1442 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1443 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1444 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1446 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1447 display property whose value is a string. If the
1448 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1449 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1450 where the display string begins. */
1451 if (newline_in_string)
1453 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1454 EMACS_INT start, end;
1455 struct it it3;
1456 int it3_moved;
1458 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1459 covered by the display string. */
1460 endpos =
1461 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1462 Qnil, Qnil);
1463 startpos =
1464 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1465 Qnil, Qnil);
1466 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1467 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1468 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1469 display property. */
1470 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1471 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1472 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1473 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1474 rightmost character on a line that is
1475 continued or word-wrapped. */
1476 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1477 && it3.c == '\n')
1478 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1479 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1480 it3.current_x
1481 + it3.pixel_width,
1482 MOVE_TO_X)
1483 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1485 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1486 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1487 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1488 fix that up. */
1489 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1490 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1493 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1494 line where we wound up. */
1495 top_y = it3.current_y;
1496 if (it3.bidi_p)
1498 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1499 the character displayed to the left of the
1500 display string could be _after_ the display
1501 property in the logical order. Use the
1502 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1503 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1504 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1505 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1506 top_y = it3.current_y;
1508 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1509 of the display line where the display string
1510 begins. */
1511 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1512 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1513 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1514 below, that means we already were at a newline
1515 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1516 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1517 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1518 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1519 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1520 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1521 it3_moved = 0;
1522 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1523 first display element whose character position is
1524 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1525 display string, which signals the end of the
1526 display line. */
1527 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1529 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1530 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1531 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1532 break;
1533 it3_moved = 1;
1534 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1536 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1537 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1538 found the display element whose character
1539 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1540 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1541 display string, move back over the glyphs
1542 produced from the string, until we find the
1543 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1544 if (it3_moved
1545 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1547 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1548 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1550 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1552 --g;
1553 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1555 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1556 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1561 *x = top_x;
1562 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1563 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1564 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1565 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1566 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1567 *vpos = it.vpos;
1570 else
1572 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1573 struct it it2;
1574 void *it2data = NULL;
1576 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1577 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1578 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1579 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1580 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1582 visible_p = 1;
1583 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1584 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1585 *x = it2.current_x;
1586 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1587 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1588 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1589 - it.last_visible_y));
1590 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1591 it.last_visible_y)
1592 - max (it2.current_y,
1593 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1594 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1596 else
1597 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1599 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1601 if (old_buffer)
1602 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1604 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1606 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1607 *x -=
1608 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1609 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1611 #if 0
1612 /* Debugging code. */
1613 if (visible_p)
1614 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1615 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1616 else
1617 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1618 #endif
1620 return visible_p;
1624 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1625 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1626 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1627 with the length of the invalid character. */
1629 static int
1630 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1632 int c;
1634 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1635 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1636 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1637 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1638 characters. */
1639 c = '?';
1641 return c;
1646 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1647 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1649 static struct text_pos
1650 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1652 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1654 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1656 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1657 int len;
1659 while (nchars--)
1661 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1662 p += len;
1663 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1664 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1667 else
1668 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1670 return pos;
1674 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1675 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1677 static struct text_pos
1678 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1680 struct text_pos pos;
1681 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1682 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1683 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1684 return pos;
1688 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1689 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1690 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1692 static struct text_pos
1693 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1695 struct text_pos pos;
1697 eassert (s != NULL);
1698 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1700 if (multibyte_p)
1702 int len;
1704 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1705 while (charpos--)
1707 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1708 s += len;
1709 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1710 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1713 else
1714 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1716 return pos;
1720 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1721 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1723 static ptrdiff_t
1724 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1726 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1728 if (multibyte_p)
1730 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1731 int len;
1732 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1734 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1736 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1737 rest -= len, p += len;
1740 else
1741 nchars = strlen (s);
1743 return nchars;
1747 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1748 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1749 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1751 static void
1752 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1754 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1755 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1757 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1758 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1759 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1760 else
1761 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1764 /* EXPORT:
1765 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1766 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1769 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1771 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1772 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1774 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1776 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1777 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1778 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1780 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1781 if (face)
1783 if (face->font)
1784 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1785 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1786 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1790 return height;
1792 #endif
1794 return 1;
1797 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1798 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1799 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1800 not force the value into range. */
1802 void
1803 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1804 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1807 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1808 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1810 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1811 even for negative values. */
1812 if (pix_x < 0)
1813 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1814 if (pix_y < 0)
1815 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1817 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1818 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1820 if (bounds)
1821 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1822 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1823 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1824 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1825 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1827 if (!noclip)
1829 if (pix_x < 0)
1830 pix_x = 0;
1831 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1832 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1834 if (pix_y < 0)
1835 pix_y = 0;
1836 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1837 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1840 #endif
1842 *x = pix_x;
1843 *y = pix_y;
1847 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1848 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1849 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1850 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1851 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1852 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1853 date. */
1855 static
1856 struct glyph *
1857 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1858 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1860 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1861 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1862 int x0, i;
1864 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1865 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1867 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1868 if (!row->enabled_p)
1869 return NULL;
1870 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1871 break;
1874 *vpos = i;
1875 *hpos = 0;
1877 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1878 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1879 return NULL;
1881 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1882 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1884 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1885 x0 = 0;
1887 else
1889 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1891 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1892 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1894 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1896 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1897 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1899 else
1901 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1902 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1906 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1907 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1908 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1909 x -= x0;
1910 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1912 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1913 ++glyph;
1916 if (glyph == end)
1917 return NULL;
1919 if (dx)
1921 *dx = x;
1922 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1925 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1926 return glyph;
1929 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1930 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1932 static void
1933 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1935 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1937 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1938 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1939 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1940 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1941 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1943 else
1945 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1946 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1950 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1952 /* EXPORT:
1953 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1954 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1957 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1959 XRectangle r;
1961 if (n <= 0)
1962 return 0;
1964 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1966 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1967 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1968 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1970 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1971 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1972 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1973 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1974 else
1975 r.height = s->height;
1977 else
1979 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1980 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1981 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1982 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1985 if (s->clip_head)
1986 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1988 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1989 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1990 else
1991 r.width = 0;
1992 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1994 if (s->clip_tail)
1995 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1997 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1998 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1999 else
2000 r.width = 0;
2003 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2004 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2005 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2006 if (s->for_overlaps)
2008 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2009 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2011 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2012 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2013 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2014 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2015 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2016 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2018 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2020 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2021 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2022 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2023 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2025 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2028 else
2030 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2031 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2032 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2033 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2034 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2035 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2036 else
2037 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2040 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2042 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2043 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2044 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2046 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2047 int height, max_y;
2049 if (s->x > r.x)
2051 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2052 r.x = s->x;
2054 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2056 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2057 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2058 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2059 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2060 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2061 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2063 r.y = max_y;
2064 r.height = height;
2066 else
2068 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2069 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2070 if (height < r.height)
2072 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2073 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2074 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2079 if (s->row->clip)
2081 XRectangle r_save = r;
2083 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2084 r.width = 0;
2087 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2088 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2090 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2091 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2092 #else
2093 *rects = r;
2094 #endif
2095 return 1;
2097 else
2099 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2100 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2101 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2102 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2103 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2104 XRectangle rs[2];
2105 #else
2106 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2107 #endif
2108 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2110 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2112 rs[i] = r;
2113 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2115 if (r.y < row_y)
2116 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2117 else
2118 rs[i].height = 0;
2120 i++;
2122 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2124 rs[i] = r;
2125 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2127 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2129 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2130 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2132 else
2133 rs[i].height = 0;
2135 i++;
2138 n = i;
2139 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2140 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2141 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2142 #endif
2143 return n;
2147 /* EXPORT:
2148 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2150 void
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2153 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2157 /* EXPORT:
2158 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2159 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2162 void
2163 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2164 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2166 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2167 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2169 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2170 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2171 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2172 width instead. */
2173 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2174 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2175 wd++; /* Why? */
2176 #endif
2178 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2179 if (x < 0)
2181 wd += x;
2182 x = 0;
2185 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2186 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2187 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2188 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2190 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2192 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2193 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2195 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2196 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2198 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2199 if (y < y0)
2201 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2202 y = y0 - 1;
2204 else
2206 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2207 if (y > y0)
2209 h += y - y0;
2210 y = y0;
2214 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2215 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2216 *heightp = h;
2220 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2223 void
2224 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2226 Lisp_Object window;
2227 struct window *w;
2228 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2229 enum window_part part;
2230 enum glyph_row_area area;
2231 int x, y, width, height;
2233 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2234 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2236 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2237 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2238 NILP (window)))
2240 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2241 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2242 goto virtual_glyph;
2245 w = XWINDOW (window);
2246 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2247 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2249 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2250 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2252 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2253 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2255 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2257 area = TEXT_AREA;
2258 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2259 goto text_glyph;
2262 switch (part)
2264 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2265 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2266 goto text_glyph;
2268 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2269 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2270 goto text_glyph;
2272 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2273 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2274 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2275 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2276 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2277 gy = gr->y;
2278 area = TEXT_AREA;
2279 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2281 case ON_TEXT:
2282 area = TEXT_AREA;
2284 text_glyph:
2285 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2286 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2287 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2289 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2290 break;
2293 text_glyph_row_found:
2294 if (gr && gy <= y)
2296 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2297 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2299 height = gr->height;
2300 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2301 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2302 break;
2304 if (g < end)
2306 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2308 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2309 image may have hot-spots. */
2310 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2311 return;
2313 width = g->pixel_width;
2315 else
2317 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2318 x -= gx;
2319 gx += (x / width) * width;
2322 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2323 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2325 else
2327 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2328 gx = (x / width) * width;
2329 y -= gy;
2330 gy += (y / height) * height;
2332 break;
2334 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2335 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2336 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2337 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2338 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2339 goto row_glyph;
2341 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2342 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2343 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2344 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2345 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2346 goto row_glyph;
2348 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2349 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2351 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2352 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2353 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2354 : 0)));
2355 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2357 row_glyph:
2358 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2359 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2360 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2362 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2363 break;
2366 if (gr && gy <= y)
2367 height = gr->height;
2368 else
2370 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2371 y -= gy;
2372 gy += (y / height) * height;
2374 break;
2376 default:
2378 virtual_glyph:
2379 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2380 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2381 as our "glyph". */
2383 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2384 round down even for negative values. */
2385 if (gx < 0)
2386 gx -= width - 1;
2387 if (gy < 0)
2388 gy -= height - 1;
2390 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2391 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2393 goto store_rect;
2396 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2397 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2399 store_rect:
2400 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2402 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2403 #if 0
2404 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2405 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2406 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2407 gx, gy, width, height);
2408 #endif
2409 #endif
2413 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2416 /***********************************************************************
2417 Lisp form evaluation
2418 ***********************************************************************/
2420 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2422 static Lisp_Object
2423 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2425 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signaled %S",
2426 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2427 return Qnil;
2430 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2431 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2432 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2434 Lisp_Object
2435 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2437 Lisp_Object val;
2439 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2440 val = Qnil;
2441 else
2443 va_list ap;
2444 ptrdiff_t i;
2445 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2446 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2447 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2449 args[0] = func;
2450 va_start (ap, func);
2451 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2452 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2453 va_end (ap);
2455 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2456 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2457 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2458 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2459 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2460 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2461 safe_eval_handler);
2462 UNGCPRO;
2463 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2466 return val;
2470 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2471 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2473 Lisp_Object
2474 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2476 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2479 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2481 Lisp_Object
2482 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2484 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2487 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2488 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2490 Lisp_Object
2491 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2493 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2498 /***********************************************************************
2499 Debugging
2500 ***********************************************************************/
2502 #if 0
2504 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2505 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2507 static void
2508 check_it (struct it *it)
2510 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2512 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2513 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2515 else
2517 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2518 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2520 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2521 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2525 if (it->dpvec)
2526 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2527 else
2528 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2531 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2533 #else /* not 0 */
2535 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2537 #endif /* not 0 */
2540 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2542 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2543 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2545 static void
2546 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2548 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2549 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2551 struct glyph_row *row;
2552 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2553 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2554 !row->enabled_p
2555 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2556 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2560 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2562 #else
2564 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2566 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2570 /***********************************************************************
2571 Iterator initialization
2572 ***********************************************************************/
2574 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2575 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2576 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2577 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2578 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2580 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2581 will produce glyphs in that row.
2583 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2584 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2585 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2586 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2588 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2589 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2590 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2591 the desired matrix of W. */
2593 void
2594 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2595 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2596 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2598 int highlight_region_p;
2599 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2601 /* Some precondition checks. */
2602 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2603 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2604 && charpos <= ZV));
2606 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2607 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2608 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2609 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2610 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2612 face_change_count = 0;
2613 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2616 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2617 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2618 remapped_base_face_id
2619 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2621 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2622 appropriate. */
2623 if (row == NULL)
2625 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2626 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2627 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2628 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2629 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2632 /* Clear IT. */
2633 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2634 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2635 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2636 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2637 it->string = Qnil;
2638 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2639 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2640 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2641 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2642 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2644 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2645 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2646 it->w = w;
2647 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2649 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2651 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2652 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2653 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2655 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2656 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2657 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2658 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2659 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2660 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2661 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2662 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2665 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2666 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2667 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2668 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2669 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2670 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2671 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2672 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2674 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2675 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2676 it->space_width = Qnil;
2677 it->font_height = Qnil;
2678 it->override_ascent = -1;
2680 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2681 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2683 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2684 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2685 invisible. */
2686 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2687 ? (clip_to_bounds
2688 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2689 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2690 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2691 ? -1 : 0));
2692 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2693 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2695 /* Display table to use. */
2696 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2698 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2699 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2701 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2702 highlight_region_p
2703 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2704 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2705 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2707 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2708 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2709 -1 to indicate no region. */
2710 if (highlight_region_p
2711 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2712 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2713 highlight_nonselected_windows
2714 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2715 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2716 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2717 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2718 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2719 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2720 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2722 ptrdiff_t markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2723 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2724 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2726 else
2727 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2729 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2730 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2731 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2732 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2733 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2734 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2735 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2736 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2737 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2739 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2741 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2742 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2743 || it->w->hscroll
2744 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2745 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2746 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2747 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2748 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2749 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2750 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2751 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2752 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2753 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2754 else
2755 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2757 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2758 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2759 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2760 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2761 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2762 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2763 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2764 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2765 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2766 #endif
2768 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2770 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2771 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2772 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2773 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2775 else
2777 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2778 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2779 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2780 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2784 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2785 above has changed them. */
2786 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2787 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2789 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2790 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2791 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2792 it->glyph_row = row;
2793 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2795 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2796 if (it->glyph_row)
2797 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2799 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2800 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2801 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2802 start of this total display area. */
2803 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2805 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2806 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2807 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2809 else
2811 it->first_visible_x =
2812 window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2813 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2814 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2816 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2817 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2818 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2819 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2820 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2821 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2822 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2823 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2825 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2826 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2827 else
2828 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2831 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2832 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2835 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2836 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2837 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2838 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2840 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2842 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2843 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2844 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2846 struct face *face;
2848 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2850 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2851 with a left box line. */
2852 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2853 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2854 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2857 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2858 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2859 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2861 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2862 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2864 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2865 handle_face_prop. */
2866 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2868 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2869 if (bytepos < charpos)
2870 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2871 else
2872 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2874 it->start = it->current;
2875 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2876 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2877 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2878 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2879 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2880 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2881 available. */
2882 it->bidi_p =
2883 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2884 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2885 && it->multibyte_p;
2887 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2888 iterator. */
2889 if (it->bidi_p)
2891 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2892 use. */
2893 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2894 Qleft_to_right))
2895 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2896 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2897 Qright_to_left))
2898 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2899 else
2900 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2901 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2902 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2903 &it->bidi_it);
2906 /* Compute faces etc. */
2907 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2910 CHECK_IT (it);
2914 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2916 void
2917 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2919 struct glyph_row *row;
2920 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2922 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2923 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2924 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2926 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2927 position is in a string or image. */
2928 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2930 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2931 int first_y = it->current_y;
2933 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2934 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2935 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2936 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2937 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2939 int new_x;
2941 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2942 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2944 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2946 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2947 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2948 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2949 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2950 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2951 end of the continued line. */
2952 if (it->current_x > 0
2953 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2954 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2955 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2956 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2957 system frame. */
2958 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2959 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2960 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
2961 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
2962 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
2964 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2965 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2966 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
2967 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
2968 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
2969 that case, as this line is not really continued.
2970 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
2971 && it->c != '\n')
2973 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2974 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2977 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2979 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
2980 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
2981 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
2982 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
2983 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
2984 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
2985 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
2987 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2988 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2989 fields in the iterator structure. */
2990 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2991 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2993 it->current_y = first_y;
2994 it->vpos = 0;
2995 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
3001 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3002 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3004 static int
3005 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3007 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3008 int ellipses_p = 0;
3009 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3011 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3012 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3013 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3014 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3015 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3016 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3017 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3018 && charpos > BEGV
3019 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3020 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3021 Qinvisible, window),
3022 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3024 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3025 window);
3026 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3029 return ellipses_p;
3033 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3034 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3035 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3036 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3038 static int
3039 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3041 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3042 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3044 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3045 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3046 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3047 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3048 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3050 --charpos;
3051 bytepos = 0;
3054 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3055 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3056 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3057 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3058 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3059 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3060 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3061 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3062 after-string. */
3063 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3065 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3066 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3067 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3068 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3070 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3071 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3073 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3074 ++s;
3076 if (s < e)
3078 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3079 break;
3083 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3084 overlay string. */
3085 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3087 int relative_index;
3089 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3090 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3091 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3092 correct the overlay string index. */
3093 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3094 pop_it (it);
3096 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3097 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3098 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3099 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3101 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3102 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3103 while (n--)
3105 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3106 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3110 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3111 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3112 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3113 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3114 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3115 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3116 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3117 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
3118 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
3119 if (it->bidi_p)
3121 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
3122 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
3123 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
3124 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
3125 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
3126 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
3127 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3128 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3130 /* Synchronize the state of the bidi iterator with
3131 pos->string_pos. For any string position other than
3132 zero, this will be done automagically when we resume
3133 iteration over the string and get_visually_first_element
3134 is called. But if string_pos is zero, and the string is
3135 to be reordered for display, we need to resync manually,
3136 since it could be that the iteration state recorded in
3137 pos ended at string_pos of 0 moving backwards in string. */
3138 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) == 0)
3140 get_visually_first_element (it);
3141 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) != 0)
3142 do {
3143 /* Paranoia. */
3144 eassert (it->bidi_it.charpos < it->bidi_it.string.schars);
3145 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
3146 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != 0);
3148 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
3149 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos);
3153 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3155 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3156 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3157 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3158 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3159 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3160 if (it->bidi_p)
3161 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3162 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3165 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3166 character translations or ellipses. */
3167 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3169 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3170 get_next_display_element (it);
3171 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3172 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3175 CHECK_IT (it);
3176 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3180 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3181 starting at ROW->start. */
3183 static void
3184 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3186 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3187 it->start = row->start;
3188 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3189 CHECK_IT (it);
3193 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3194 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3195 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3196 end position. */
3198 static int
3199 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3201 int success = 0;
3203 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3205 if (row->continued_p)
3206 it->continuation_lines_width
3207 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3208 CHECK_IT (it);
3209 success = 1;
3212 return success;
3218 /***********************************************************************
3219 Text properties
3220 ***********************************************************************/
3222 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3223 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3224 to stop. */
3226 static void
3227 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3229 enum prop_handled handled;
3230 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3231 struct props *p;
3233 it->dpvec = NULL;
3234 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3235 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3236 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3237 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3239 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3240 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3241 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3245 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3247 /* Call text property handlers. */
3248 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3250 handled = p->handler (it);
3252 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3253 break;
3254 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3256 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3257 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3258 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3259 || it->sp > 1
3260 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3261 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3262 will load them again and push the iterator state
3263 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3264 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3265 overlay strings. */
3266 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3267 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3268 : 0))
3270 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3271 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3272 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3273 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3274 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3275 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3276 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3277 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3278 pop_it (it);
3279 return;
3281 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3282 pop_it (it);
3283 else
3285 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3286 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3287 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3288 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3290 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3291 break;
3293 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3294 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3297 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3299 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3300 characters from a display vector. */
3301 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3302 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3304 /* Handle overlay changes.
3305 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3306 if it finds overlays. */
3307 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3308 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3311 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3313 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3314 break;
3317 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3319 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3320 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3321 compute_stop_pos (it);
3325 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3326 information for IT's current position. */
3328 static void
3329 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3331 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3332 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3333 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3335 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3337 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3338 properties. */
3339 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3340 object = it->string;
3341 limit = Qnil;
3342 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3343 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3345 else
3347 ptrdiff_t pos;
3349 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3350 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3351 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3352 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3353 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3355 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3356 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3357 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3358 follows. */
3359 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3360 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3361 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3362 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3363 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3365 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3366 start or end because the face might change there. */
3367 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3369 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3370 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3371 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3372 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3375 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3376 property changes. */
3377 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3378 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3381 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3382 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3383 position = make_number (charpos);
3384 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3385 if (iv)
3387 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3388 struct props *p;
3390 /* Get properties here. */
3391 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3392 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3394 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3395 properties. */
3396 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3397 (next_iv
3398 && (NILP (limit)
3399 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3400 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3402 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3404 Lisp_Object new_value;
3406 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3407 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3408 break;
3411 if (p->handler)
3412 break;
3415 if (next_iv)
3417 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3418 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3419 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3420 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3421 else
3422 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3423 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3427 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3429 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3431 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3432 stoppos = -1;
3433 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3434 stoppos, it->string);
3437 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3438 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3439 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3443 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3444 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3445 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3446 xmalloc. */
3448 static ptrdiff_t
3449 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3451 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3452 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3453 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3455 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3456 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3458 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3459 use its ending point instead. */
3460 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3462 Lisp_Object oend;
3463 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3465 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3466 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3467 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3470 return endpos;
3473 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3474 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3475 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3476 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3478 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3479 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3480 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3481 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3482 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3483 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3484 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3485 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3486 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3487 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3488 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3489 white space in the text area. */
3490 ptrdiff_t
3491 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3492 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3493 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3495 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3496 Lisp_Object object =
3497 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3498 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3499 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3500 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3501 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3502 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3503 ptrdiff_t lim =
3504 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3505 struct text_pos tpos;
3506 int rv = 0;
3508 *disp_prop = 1;
3510 if (charpos >= eob
3511 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3512 that have display string properties. */
3513 || string->from_disp_str
3514 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3515 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3517 *disp_prop = 0;
3518 return eob;
3521 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3522 return CHARPOS. */
3523 pos = make_number (charpos);
3524 if (STRINGP (object))
3525 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3526 else
3527 bufpos = charpos;
3528 tpos = *position;
3529 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3530 && (charpos <= begb
3531 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3532 object),
3533 spec))
3534 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3535 frame_window_p)))
3537 if (rv == 2)
3538 *disp_prop = 2;
3539 return charpos;
3542 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3543 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3544 limpos = make_number (lim);
3545 do {
3546 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3547 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3548 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3550 *disp_prop = 0;
3551 break;
3553 if (STRINGP (object))
3554 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3555 else
3556 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3557 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3558 if (!STRINGP (object))
3559 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3560 } while (NILP (spec)
3561 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3562 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3563 if (rv == 2)
3564 *disp_prop = 2;
3566 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3569 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3570 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3571 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3572 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3573 value is a string. */
3574 ptrdiff_t
3575 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3577 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3578 Lisp_Object object =
3579 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3580 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3581 ptrdiff_t eob =
3582 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3584 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3585 return eob;
3587 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3588 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3589 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3590 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3591 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3592 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3593 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3594 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3595 how this is handled.
3597 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3598 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3599 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3600 stop_charpos is. */
3601 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3602 return -1;
3604 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3605 changes. */
3606 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3608 return XFASTINT (pos);
3613 /***********************************************************************
3614 Fontification
3615 ***********************************************************************/
3617 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3618 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3619 regions of text. */
3621 static enum prop_handled
3622 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3624 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3625 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3627 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3628 return handled;
3630 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3631 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3632 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3633 Qfontification_functions. */
3634 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3635 && it->s == NULL
3636 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3637 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3638 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3639 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3640 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3641 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3642 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3644 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3645 Lisp_Object val;
3646 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3647 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3648 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3650 val = Vfontification_functions;
3651 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3653 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3655 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3656 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3657 else
3659 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3660 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3662 fns = Qnil;
3663 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3665 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3667 fn = XCAR (val);
3669 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3671 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3672 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3673 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3674 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3675 loop. */
3676 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3677 CONSP (fns);
3678 fns = XCDR (fns))
3680 fn = XCAR (fns);
3681 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3682 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3685 else
3686 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3689 UNGCPRO;
3692 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3694 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3695 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3696 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3697 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3698 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3699 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3700 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3701 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3703 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3704 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3706 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3707 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3708 else if (BUFFER_LIVE_P (obuf))
3709 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3711 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3712 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3713 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3714 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3715 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3716 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3718 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3719 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3720 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3721 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3722 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3725 return handled;
3730 /***********************************************************************
3731 Faces
3732 ***********************************************************************/
3734 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3735 Called from handle_stop. */
3737 static enum prop_handled
3738 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3740 int new_face_id;
3741 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3743 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3745 new_face_id
3746 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3747 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3748 it->region_beg_charpos,
3749 it->region_end_charpos,
3750 &next_stop,
3751 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3752 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3753 0, it->base_face_id);
3755 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3756 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3757 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3758 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3759 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3760 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3761 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3763 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3765 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3766 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3767 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3768 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3769 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3770 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3771 it->start_of_box_run_p
3772 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3773 && (it->face_id >= 0
3774 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3775 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3776 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3779 else
3781 int base_face_id;
3782 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3783 int i;
3784 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3785 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3786 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3787 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3788 : Qnil);
3790 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3791 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3792 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3793 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3795 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3796 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3797 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3799 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3800 from_overlay
3801 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3802 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3803 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3804 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3806 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3807 break;
3810 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3812 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3813 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3814 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3815 base_face_id
3816 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3817 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3818 it->region_beg_charpos,
3819 it->region_end_charpos,
3820 &next_stop,
3821 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3822 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3824 from_overlay);
3826 else
3828 bufpos = 0;
3830 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3831 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3832 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3833 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3834 faces. */
3835 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3836 ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
3837 : underlying_face_id (it);
3840 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3841 it->string,
3842 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3843 bufpos,
3844 it->region_beg_charpos,
3845 it->region_end_charpos,
3846 &next_stop,
3847 base_face_id, 0);
3849 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3850 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3851 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3852 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3853 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3854 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3855 is really the end. */
3856 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3858 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3859 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3861 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3862 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3863 shadow on the left side. */
3864 it->start_of_box_run_p
3865 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3866 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3870 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3871 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3875 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3876 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3877 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3878 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3880 static int
3881 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3883 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3885 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3887 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3888 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3889 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3891 return face_id;
3895 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3896 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3897 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3898 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3900 static int
3901 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3903 int face_id, limit;
3904 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3905 struct it it_copy;
3906 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3908 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3910 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3912 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3913 int base_face_id;
3915 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3916 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3917 string start. */
3918 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3919 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3920 return it->face_id;
3922 if (!it->bidi_p)
3924 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3925 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3926 case is the same as the visual order. */
3927 if (before_p)
3928 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3929 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3930 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3931 composition. */
3932 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3933 else
3934 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3936 else
3938 if (before_p)
3940 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3941 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3942 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3943 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3944 family of functions. */
3945 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3946 character on this display line. */
3947 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3948 return it->face_id;
3949 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3950 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3951 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3952 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3953 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3954 cases here. */
3955 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3956 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3957 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3958 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3960 else
3962 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3963 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3964 order. */
3965 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3967 it_copy = *it;
3968 while (n--)
3969 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3971 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3974 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3976 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3977 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3978 else
3979 bufpos = 0;
3981 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3983 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3984 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3985 it->string,
3986 charpos,
3987 bufpos,
3988 it->region_beg_charpos,
3989 it->region_end_charpos,
3990 &next_check_charpos,
3991 base_face_id, 0);
3993 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3994 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3995 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3996 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3998 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3999 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
4000 int c, len;
4001 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4003 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
4004 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
4007 else
4009 struct text_pos pos;
4011 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
4012 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
4013 return it->face_id;
4015 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
4016 pos = it->current.pos;
4018 if (!it->bidi_p)
4020 if (before_p)
4021 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4022 else
4024 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
4026 /* For composition, we must check the position after
4027 the composition. */
4028 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
4029 pos.bytepos += it->len;
4031 else
4032 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4035 else
4037 if (before_p)
4039 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4040 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4041 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4042 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4043 family of functions. */
4044 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4045 character on this display line. */
4046 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4047 return it->face_id;
4048 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4049 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4050 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4051 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4052 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4053 cases here. */
4054 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4055 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4056 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4057 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4059 else
4061 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4062 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4063 order. */
4064 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4066 it_copy = *it;
4067 while (n--)
4068 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4070 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4071 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4074 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4076 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4077 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4078 CHARPOS (pos),
4079 it->region_beg_charpos,
4080 it->region_end_charpos,
4081 &next_check_charpos,
4082 limit, 0, -1);
4084 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4085 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4086 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4087 if (it->multibyte_p)
4089 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4090 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4091 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4095 return face_id;
4100 /***********************************************************************
4101 Invisible text
4102 ***********************************************************************/
4104 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4105 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4107 static enum prop_handled
4108 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4110 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4111 int invis_p;
4112 Lisp_Object prop;
4114 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4116 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4118 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4119 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4120 property. */
4121 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4122 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4123 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4125 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4127 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4128 invisible text. */
4129 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4130 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4132 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4134 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4135 found in IT->string, if any. */
4136 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4137 XSETINT (limit, len);
4140 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4141 it->string, limit);
4142 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4144 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4145 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4146 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4147 if (invis_p == 2)
4148 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4151 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4153 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4154 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4156 if (endpos < len)
4158 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4159 struct text_pos old;
4160 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4162 old = it->current.string_pos;
4163 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4164 if (it->bidi_p)
4166 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4167 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4168 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4169 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4170 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4173 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4175 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4176 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4178 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4179 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4180 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4181 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4183 else
4185 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4186 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4189 else
4191 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4192 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4193 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4194 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4195 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4197 next_overlay_string (it);
4198 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4199 finished processing them. */
4200 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4202 else
4204 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4205 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4210 else
4212 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4213 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4215 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4216 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4217 pos = make_number (tem);
4218 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4219 &overlay);
4220 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4222 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4223 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4225 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4226 invisible text. */
4227 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4229 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4231 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4232 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4235 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4236 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4237 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4238 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4239 invisible property. */
4240 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4242 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4243 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4244 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4245 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4246 invis_p = 0;
4247 else
4249 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4250 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4251 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4252 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4253 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4254 newpos is visible. */
4255 pos = make_number (newpos);
4256 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4257 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4260 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4261 skip starting with next_stop. */
4262 if (invis_p)
4263 tem = next_stop;
4265 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4266 second one's ellipsis. */
4267 if (invis_p == 2)
4268 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4270 while (invis_p);
4272 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4273 if (it->bidi_p)
4275 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4276 int on_newline =
4277 bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4278 int after_newline =
4279 newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4281 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4282 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4283 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4284 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4285 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4286 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4287 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4288 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4290 struct text_pos tpos;
4291 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4293 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4294 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4295 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4296 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4297 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4298 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4299 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4300 if (on_newline)
4302 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4303 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4304 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4305 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4306 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4309 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4311 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4312 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4313 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4314 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4315 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4316 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4317 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4318 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4319 displayed text when invisible properties are
4320 added or removed. */
4321 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4323 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4324 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4325 need to do it now because
4326 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4327 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4328 text at the beginning, which resets the
4329 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4330 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4331 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4335 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4337 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4338 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4339 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4340 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4341 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4342 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4343 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4344 invisible region again. */
4345 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4346 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4349 else
4351 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4352 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4355 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4356 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4357 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4358 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4359 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4360 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4361 if (NILP (overlay)
4362 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4364 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4365 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4367 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4369 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4370 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4371 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4372 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4373 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4375 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4376 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4377 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4378 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4379 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4380 first invisible character. */
4381 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4383 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4384 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4386 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4387 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4388 considering any properties of the following char.
4389 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4390 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4395 return handled;
4399 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4400 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4402 static void
4403 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4405 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4406 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4407 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4409 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4410 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4411 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4413 else
4415 /* Default `...'. */
4416 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4417 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4420 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4421 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4422 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4424 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4425 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4426 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4427 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4428 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4430 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4431 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4436 /***********************************************************************
4437 'display' property
4438 ***********************************************************************/
4440 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4441 Called from handle_stop.
4442 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4443 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4444 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4446 static enum prop_handled
4447 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4449 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4450 struct text_pos *position;
4451 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4452 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4453 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4455 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4457 object = it->string;
4458 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4459 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4461 else
4463 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4464 position = &it->current.pos;
4465 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4468 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4469 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4470 it->space_width = Qnil;
4471 it->font_height = Qnil;
4472 it->voffset = 0;
4474 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4475 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4476 `display' property etc. */
4477 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4478 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4480 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4481 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4482 if (NILP (propval))
4483 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4484 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4485 if it was a text property. */
4487 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4488 object = it->w->buffer;
4490 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4491 position, bufpos,
4492 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4494 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4497 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4498 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4499 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4500 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4501 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4502 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4504 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4505 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4506 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4508 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4509 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4510 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4511 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4512 spec. */
4513 static int
4514 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4515 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4516 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4518 int replacing_p = 0;
4519 int rv;
4521 if (CONSP (spec)
4522 /* Simple specifications. */
4523 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4524 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4525 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4526 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4527 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4528 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4529 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4530 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4531 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4532 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4533 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4534 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4536 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4538 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4539 overlay, position, bufpos,
4540 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4542 replacing_p = rv;
4543 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4544 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4545 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4546 break;
4550 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4552 ptrdiff_t i;
4553 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4554 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4555 overlay, position, bufpos,
4556 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4558 replacing_p = rv;
4559 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4560 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4561 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4562 break;
4565 else
4567 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4568 position, bufpos, 0,
4569 frame_window_p)))
4570 replacing_p = rv;
4573 return replacing_p;
4576 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4577 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4579 static struct text_pos
4580 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4582 Lisp_Object end;
4583 struct text_pos end_pos;
4585 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4586 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4587 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4588 if (STRINGP (object))
4589 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4590 else
4591 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4593 return end_pos;
4597 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4598 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4599 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4600 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4601 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4602 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4603 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4604 properties after the first one has been processed.
4606 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4607 or nil if it was a text property.
4609 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4610 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4611 property ends.
4613 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4614 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4615 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4617 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4618 of buffer or string text. */
4620 static int
4621 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4622 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4623 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4624 int frame_window_p)
4626 Lisp_Object form;
4627 Lisp_Object location, value;
4628 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4629 int valid_p;
4631 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4632 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4633 form = Qt;
4634 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4636 spec = XCDR (spec);
4637 if (!CONSP (spec))
4638 return 0;
4639 form = XCAR (spec);
4640 spec = XCDR (spec);
4643 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4645 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4646 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4648 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4649 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4650 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4651 to the current position in the buffer. */
4653 if (NILP (object))
4654 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4655 specbind (Qobject, object);
4656 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4657 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4658 GCPRO1 (form);
4659 form = safe_eval (form);
4660 UNGCPRO;
4661 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4664 if (NILP (form))
4665 return 0;
4667 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4668 if (CONSP (spec)
4669 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4670 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4672 if (it)
4674 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4675 return 0;
4677 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4678 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4680 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4681 int new_height = -1;
4683 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4684 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4685 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4686 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4687 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4689 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4690 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4691 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4692 steps = - steps;
4693 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4695 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4697 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4698 Value is the new height. */
4699 Lisp_Object height;
4700 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4701 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4702 if (NUMBERP (height))
4703 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4705 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4707 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4708 struct face *f;
4710 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4711 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4712 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4713 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4715 else
4717 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4718 current specified height to get the new height. */
4719 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4721 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4722 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4723 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4725 if (NUMBERP (value))
4726 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4729 if (new_height > 0)
4730 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4734 return 0;
4737 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4738 if (CONSP (spec)
4739 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4740 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4742 if (it)
4744 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4745 return 0;
4747 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4748 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4749 it->space_width = value;
4752 return 0;
4755 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4756 if (CONSP (spec)
4757 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4759 Lisp_Object tem;
4761 if (it)
4763 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4764 return 0;
4766 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4768 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4769 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4771 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4772 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4774 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4775 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4776 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4782 return 0;
4785 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4786 if (CONSP (spec)
4787 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4788 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4790 if (it)
4792 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4793 return 0;
4795 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4796 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4797 if (NUMBERP (value))
4799 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4800 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4801 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4803 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4806 return 0;
4809 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4810 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4811 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4812 return 0;
4814 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4815 we have to find the end of the property. */
4816 if (it)
4818 start_pos = *position;
4819 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4821 value = Qnil;
4823 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4824 text properties change there. */
4825 if (it)
4826 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4828 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4829 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4830 if (CONSP (spec)
4831 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4832 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4833 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4835 int fringe_bitmap;
4837 if (it)
4839 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4840 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4841 across the text with this property. */
4843 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4844 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4845 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4846 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4847 if (it->bidi_p)
4849 it->position = *position;
4850 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4851 *position = it->position;
4853 return 1;
4856 else if (!frame_window_p)
4857 return 1;
4859 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4860 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4861 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4862 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4863 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4864 across the text with this property. */
4866 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4868 it->position = *position;
4869 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4870 *position = it->position;
4872 return 1;
4875 if (it)
4877 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4879 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4881 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4882 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4883 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4884 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4885 face_id = face_id2;
4888 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4889 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4890 push_it (it, position);
4892 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4893 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4894 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4895 it->position = start_pos;
4896 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4897 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4898 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4899 it->face_id = face_id;
4900 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4902 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4903 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4904 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4905 *position = start_pos;
4907 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4909 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4910 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4912 else
4914 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4915 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4918 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4919 return 1;
4922 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4923 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4924 prefixes for display specifications. */
4925 location = Qunbound;
4926 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4928 Lisp_Object tem;
4930 value = XCDR (spec);
4931 if (CONSP (value))
4932 value = XCAR (value);
4934 tem = XCAR (spec);
4935 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4936 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4937 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4938 (NILP (tem)
4939 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4940 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4941 location = tem;
4944 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4946 location = Qnil;
4947 value = spec;
4950 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4951 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4952 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4954 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4955 `right-margin' or nil. */
4957 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4958 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4959 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4960 && valid_image_p (value))
4961 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4962 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4964 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4966 int retval = 1;
4968 if (!it)
4970 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4971 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4972 display. */
4973 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4974 retval = 2;
4975 return retval;
4978 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4979 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4980 push_it (it, position);
4981 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4982 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4984 if (NILP (location))
4985 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4986 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4987 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4988 else
4989 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4991 if (STRINGP (value))
4993 it->string = value;
4994 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4995 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4996 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4997 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4998 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4999 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5000 it->prev_stop = 0;
5001 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5002 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
5003 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5004 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5005 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5006 if (BUFFERP (object))
5007 *position = start_pos;
5009 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5010 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
5011 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
5012 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5013 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5014 else
5015 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5017 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
5018 if (it->bidi_p)
5020 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5021 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5022 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
5023 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
5024 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
5025 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5026 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5029 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
5031 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
5032 it->object = value;
5033 *position = it->position = start_pos;
5034 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
5036 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
5037 else
5039 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5040 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5041 it->position = start_pos;
5042 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
5043 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5045 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5046 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5047 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5048 *position = start_pos;
5050 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5052 return retval;
5055 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5056 POSITION to what it was before. */
5057 *position = start_pos;
5058 return 0;
5061 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5062 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5063 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5064 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5067 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5068 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5070 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5071 struct text_pos position;
5073 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5074 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5075 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5079 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5081 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5082 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5083 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5084 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5085 modified in sync. */
5087 static int
5088 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5090 if (EQ (string, prop))
5091 return 1;
5093 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5094 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5096 prop = XCDR (prop);
5097 if (!CONSP (prop))
5098 return 0;
5099 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5100 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5101 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5102 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5103 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5104 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5105 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5106 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5107 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5108 its result is non-nil. */
5109 prop = XCDR (prop);
5112 if (CONSP (prop))
5113 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5114 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5116 prop = XCDR (prop);
5117 if (!CONSP (prop))
5118 return 0;
5120 prop = XCDR (prop);
5121 if (!CONSP (prop))
5122 return 0;
5125 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5129 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5131 static int
5132 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5134 if (CONSP (prop)
5135 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5136 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5138 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5139 while (CONSP (prop))
5141 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5142 return 1;
5143 prop = XCDR (prop);
5146 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5148 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5149 ptrdiff_t i;
5150 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5151 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5152 return 1;
5154 else
5155 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5157 return 0;
5160 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5161 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5162 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5163 less than FROM).
5164 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5165 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5167 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5168 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5170 static ptrdiff_t
5171 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5172 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5174 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5175 int found = 0;
5177 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5179 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5181 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5182 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5184 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5185 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5186 found = 1;
5187 else
5188 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5189 limit);
5192 else /* looking back */
5194 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5195 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5197 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5198 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5199 found = 1;
5200 else
5201 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5202 limit);
5206 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5209 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5210 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5211 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5213 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5214 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5215 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5216 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5218 static ptrdiff_t
5219 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5221 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5222 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5223 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5226 if (!found)
5227 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5228 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5229 return found;
5234 /***********************************************************************
5235 `composition' property
5236 ***********************************************************************/
5238 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5239 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5241 static enum prop_handled
5242 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5244 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5245 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5247 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5249 unsigned char *s;
5251 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5252 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5253 string = it->string;
5254 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5255 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5257 else
5259 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5260 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5261 string = Qnil;
5262 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5265 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5266 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5267 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5268 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5269 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5270 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5272 if (start < pos)
5273 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5274 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5275 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5276 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5277 if (start != pos)
5279 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5280 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5281 else
5282 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5284 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5285 prop, string);
5287 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5289 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5290 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5291 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5295 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5300 /***********************************************************************
5301 Overlay strings
5302 ***********************************************************************/
5304 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5305 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5307 struct overlay_entry
5309 Lisp_Object overlay;
5310 Lisp_Object string;
5311 EMACS_INT priority;
5312 int after_string_p;
5316 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5317 Called from handle_stop. */
5319 static enum prop_handled
5320 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5322 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5323 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5324 else
5325 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5329 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5330 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5331 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5332 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5333 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5334 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5336 static void
5337 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5339 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5340 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5342 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5343 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5344 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5346 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5347 pop_it (it);
5348 eassert (it->sp > 0
5349 || (NILP (it->string)
5350 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5351 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5352 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5353 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5354 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5355 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5356 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5357 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5358 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5359 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5360 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5361 pop_it (it);
5363 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5364 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5365 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5366 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5367 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5369 else
5371 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5372 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5373 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5374 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5375 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5376 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5377 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5379 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5380 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5382 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5383 string. */
5384 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5385 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5386 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5387 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5388 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5389 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5390 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5391 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5392 it->prev_stop = 0;
5393 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5395 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5396 if (it->bidi_p)
5398 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5399 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5400 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5401 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5402 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5403 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5404 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5408 CHECK_IT (it);
5412 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5413 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5414 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5416 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5417 when they come from the same overlay.
5419 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5420 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5422 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5423 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5425 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5428 static int
5429 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5431 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5432 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5433 int result;
5435 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5437 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5438 they come from different overlays. */
5439 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5440 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5441 else
5442 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5444 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5446 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5447 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5448 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5449 else
5450 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5451 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5453 else
5454 result = 0;
5456 return result;
5460 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5461 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5462 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5464 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5465 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5466 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5467 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5468 function.
5470 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5471 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5472 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5473 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5474 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5475 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5476 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5477 in this case.
5479 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5480 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5481 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5482 compare_overlay_entries. */
5484 static void
5485 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5487 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5488 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5489 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5490 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5491 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5492 int invis_p;
5493 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5494 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5496 if (charpos <= 0)
5497 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5499 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5500 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5501 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5502 OVERLAY. */
5503 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5504 do \
5506 Lisp_Object priority; \
5508 if (n == size) \
5510 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5511 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5512 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5513 size *= 2; \
5516 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5517 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5518 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5519 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5520 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5521 ++n; \
5523 while (0)
5525 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5526 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5528 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5529 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5530 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5531 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5533 if (end < charpos)
5534 break;
5536 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5537 position. */
5538 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5539 continue;
5541 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5542 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5543 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5544 continue;
5546 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5547 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5548 end position are indistinguishable. */
5549 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5550 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5552 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5553 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5554 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5555 && SCHARS (str))
5556 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5558 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5559 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5560 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5561 && SCHARS (str))
5562 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5565 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5566 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5568 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5569 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5570 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5571 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5573 if (start > charpos)
5574 break;
5576 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5577 position. */
5578 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5579 continue;
5581 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5582 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5583 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5584 continue;
5586 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5587 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5588 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5589 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5591 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5592 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5593 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5594 && SCHARS (str))
5595 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5597 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5598 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5599 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5600 && SCHARS (str))
5601 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5604 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5606 /* Sort entries. */
5607 if (n > 1)
5608 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5610 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5611 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5612 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5614 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5615 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5616 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5617 i = 0;
5618 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5619 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5621 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5622 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5625 CHECK_IT (it);
5626 SAFE_FREE ();
5630 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5631 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5632 least one overlay string was found. */
5634 static int
5635 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5637 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5638 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5639 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5640 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5641 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5642 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5643 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5644 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5645 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5647 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5648 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5649 from current_buffer. */
5650 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5652 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5653 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5654 strings. */
5655 if (compute_stop_p)
5656 compute_stop_pos (it);
5657 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5659 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5660 strings have been processed. */
5661 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5663 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5664 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5665 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5666 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5667 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5668 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5669 in case of an empty display string is in
5670 next_overlay_string.) */
5671 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5672 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5673 push_it (it, NULL);
5675 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5676 string. */
5677 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5678 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5679 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5680 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5681 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5682 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5683 it->prev_stop = 0;
5684 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5685 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5686 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5687 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5689 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5690 buffer. */
5691 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5692 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5693 else
5694 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5696 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5697 if (it->bidi_p)
5699 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5701 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5702 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5703 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5704 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5705 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5706 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5707 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5709 return 1;
5712 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5713 return 0;
5716 static int
5717 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5719 it->string = Qnil;
5720 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5722 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5724 CHECK_IT (it);
5726 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5727 return STRINGP (it->string);
5732 /***********************************************************************
5733 Saving and restoring state
5734 ***********************************************************************/
5736 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5737 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5738 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5739 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5740 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5742 static void
5743 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5745 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5747 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5748 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5750 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5751 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5752 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5753 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5754 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5755 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5756 p->string = it->string;
5757 p->method = it->method;
5758 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5759 switch (p->method)
5761 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5762 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5763 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5764 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5765 break;
5766 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5767 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5768 break;
5770 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5771 p->current = it->current;
5772 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5773 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5774 p->area = it->area;
5775 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5776 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5777 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5778 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5779 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5780 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5781 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5782 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5783 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5784 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5785 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5786 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5787 ++it->sp;
5789 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5790 if (it->bidi_p)
5791 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5794 static void
5795 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5797 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5798 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5799 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5801 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5803 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5804 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5805 chance to do that. */
5806 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5807 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5808 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5809 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5810 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5811 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5812 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5813 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5814 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5815 back, maybe. */
5816 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5817 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5818 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5819 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5820 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5821 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5822 if (buffer_p)
5823 it->current.pos = it->position;
5824 else
5825 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5828 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5829 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5830 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5831 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5832 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5834 static void
5835 pop_it (struct it *it)
5837 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5838 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5840 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5841 --it->sp;
5842 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5843 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5844 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5845 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5846 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5847 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5848 it->current = p->current;
5849 it->position = p->position;
5850 it->string = p->string;
5851 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5852 if (NILP (it->string))
5853 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5854 it->method = p->method;
5855 switch (it->method)
5857 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5858 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5859 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5860 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5861 break;
5862 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5863 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5864 break;
5865 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5866 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5867 break;
5868 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5869 it->object = it->string;
5870 break;
5871 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5872 if (it->s)
5873 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5874 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5875 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5876 else
5878 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5879 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5882 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5883 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5884 it->area = p->area;
5885 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5886 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5887 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5888 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5889 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5890 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5891 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5892 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5893 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5894 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5895 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5896 if (it->bidi_p)
5898 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5899 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5900 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5901 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5902 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5903 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5904 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5905 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5906 if (from_display_prop
5907 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5908 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5910 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5911 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5912 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5913 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5914 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5915 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5916 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5922 /***********************************************************************
5923 Moving over lines
5924 ***********************************************************************/
5926 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5928 static void
5929 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5931 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5932 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5936 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5938 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5939 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5940 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5941 of *SKIPPED_P.
5943 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5944 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5946 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5947 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5948 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5950 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5951 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5952 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5953 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5954 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5955 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5957 static int
5958 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5959 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5961 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
5962 int newline_found_p, n;
5963 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5965 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5966 skipping over invisible text below. */
5967 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5968 && it->c == '\n'
5969 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5971 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5972 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5973 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5974 it->c = 0;
5975 return 1;
5978 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5979 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5980 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5981 calls this function. */
5982 old_selective = it->selective;
5983 it->selective = 0;
5985 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5986 from buffer text. */
5987 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5988 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5989 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5991 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5992 return 0;
5993 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5994 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5995 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5996 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5999 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
6000 short-cut. */
6001 if (!newline_found_p)
6003 ptrdiff_t start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6004 ptrdiff_t limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
6005 Lisp_Object pos;
6007 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
6009 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
6010 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
6011 buffer text. */
6012 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
6013 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
6014 Qdisplay, Qnil,
6015 make_number (limit)),
6016 NILP (pos))
6017 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
6019 if (!it->bidi_p)
6021 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6022 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
6024 else
6026 struct bidi_it bprev;
6028 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
6029 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
6030 none up to `limit'. */
6031 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
6033 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
6034 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
6036 do {
6037 bprev = it->bidi_it;
6038 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6039 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6040 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6041 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6042 if (bidi_it_prev)
6043 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6045 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
6047 else
6049 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6050 && !newline_found_p)
6052 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6053 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6054 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6055 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6060 it->selective = old_selective;
6061 return newline_found_p;
6065 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6066 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6067 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6068 IT->hpos. */
6070 static void
6071 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6073 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6075 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6077 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6078 break;
6080 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6081 invisible. */
6082 if (it->selective > 0
6083 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6084 it->selective))
6085 continue;
6087 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6089 Lisp_Object prop;
6090 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6091 Qinvisible, it->window);
6092 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6093 continue;
6096 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6097 break;
6100 struct it it2;
6101 void *it2data = NULL;
6102 ptrdiff_t pos;
6103 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6104 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6106 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6108 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6109 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6110 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6111 goto replaced;
6113 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6114 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6115 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6116 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6117 it2.sp = 0;
6118 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6119 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6120 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6121 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6122 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6123 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6124 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6125 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6126 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6128 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6129 goto replaced;
6132 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6133 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6134 break;
6136 replaced:
6137 if (beg < BEGV)
6138 beg = BEGV;
6139 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6140 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6144 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6146 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6147 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6148 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6149 CHECK_IT (it);
6153 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6154 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6155 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6156 face information etc. */
6158 void
6159 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6161 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6162 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6163 CHECK_IT (it);
6167 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6168 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6169 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6170 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6171 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6172 is invisible because of text properties. */
6174 static void
6175 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6177 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6178 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6180 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6182 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6183 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6184 if (it->selective > 0)
6185 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6186 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6187 it->selective))
6189 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6190 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6191 newline_found_p =
6192 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6195 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6196 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6198 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6200 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6202 if (!it->bidi_p)
6204 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6205 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6207 else
6209 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6210 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6211 position with that. */
6212 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6213 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6214 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6218 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6220 if (!it->bidi_p)
6222 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6223 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6225 else
6227 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6228 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6229 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6230 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6231 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6233 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6236 else if (skipped_p)
6237 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6239 CHECK_IT (it);
6244 /***********************************************************************
6245 Changing an iterator's position
6246 ***********************************************************************/
6248 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6249 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6250 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6251 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6253 static void
6254 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6256 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6258 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6260 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6261 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6262 if (force_p
6263 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6264 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6266 if (it->bidi_p)
6268 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6269 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6270 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6271 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6272 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6273 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6274 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6275 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6276 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6277 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6278 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6279 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6280 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6281 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6282 handle_stop (it);
6284 else
6286 handle_stop (it);
6287 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6292 CHECK_IT (it);
6296 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6297 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6299 static void
6300 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6302 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6303 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6305 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6306 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6308 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6309 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6310 it->dpvec = NULL;
6311 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6312 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6313 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6314 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6315 it->string = Qnil;
6316 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6317 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6318 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6319 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6320 it->sp = 0;
6321 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6322 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6324 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6325 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6326 if (it->bidi_p)
6328 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6329 &it->bidi_it);
6330 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6331 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6332 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6333 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6334 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6335 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6338 if (set_stop_p)
6340 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6341 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6343 /* This make the information stored in it->cmp_it invalidate. */
6344 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6348 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6349 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6350 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6352 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6353 characters from the string.
6355 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6356 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6357 field width.
6359 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6360 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6361 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6363 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6364 calling this function. */
6366 static void
6367 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6368 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6369 int multibyte)
6371 /* No region in strings. */
6372 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6374 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6375 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6377 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6378 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6379 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6380 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6381 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6383 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6384 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6385 if (multibyte >= 0)
6386 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6388 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6389 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6390 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6391 not yet available. */
6392 it->bidi_p =
6393 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6394 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6396 if (s == NULL)
6398 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6399 it->string = string;
6400 it->s = NULL;
6401 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6402 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6403 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6405 if (it->bidi_p)
6407 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6408 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6409 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6410 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6411 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6412 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6413 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6414 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6417 else
6419 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6420 it->string = Qnil;
6422 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6423 for displaying C strings. */
6424 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6425 if (it->multibyte_p)
6427 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6428 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6430 else
6432 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6433 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6436 if (it->bidi_p)
6438 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6439 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6440 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6441 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6442 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6443 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6444 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6445 &it->bidi_it);
6447 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6450 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6451 from the string. */
6452 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6454 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6455 if (it->bidi_p)
6456 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6459 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6460 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6461 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6462 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6463 if (field_width < 0)
6464 field_width = INFINITY;
6465 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6466 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6467 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6468 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6469 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6471 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6472 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6473 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6475 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6476 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6477 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6478 if (it->bidi_p)
6480 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6481 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6482 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6484 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6486 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6487 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6488 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6489 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6490 it->string);
6492 CHECK_IT (it);
6497 /***********************************************************************
6498 Iteration
6499 ***********************************************************************/
6501 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6503 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6505 next_element_from_buffer,
6506 next_element_from_display_vector,
6507 next_element_from_string,
6508 next_element_from_c_string,
6509 next_element_from_image,
6510 next_element_from_stretch
6513 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6516 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6517 (possibly with the following characters). */
6519 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6520 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6521 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6522 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6523 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6524 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6525 (IT)->string)))
6528 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6529 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6530 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6531 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6532 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6533 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6535 Lisp_Object
6536 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6538 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6540 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6541 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6543 if (c >= 0)
6545 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6546 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6547 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6548 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6549 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6551 else
6552 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6555 retry:
6556 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6558 if (c >= 0)
6559 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6560 return Qnil;
6561 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6562 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6564 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6566 if (c >= 0)
6567 return glyphless_method;
6568 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6569 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6571 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6572 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6573 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6574 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6575 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6576 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6577 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6578 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6579 else
6581 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6582 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6583 goto retry;
6585 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6586 return glyphless_method;
6589 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6590 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6591 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6593 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6594 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6595 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6597 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6598 int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6599 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6601 static int
6602 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6604 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6605 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6606 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6607 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6608 int success_p;
6610 get_next:
6611 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6613 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6615 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6616 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6617 is R..." */
6618 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6619 tables? */
6620 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6621 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6622 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6623 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6624 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6625 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6626 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6627 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6628 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6629 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6630 it? */
6631 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6633 Lisp_Object dv;
6634 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6635 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6636 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6637 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6639 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6641 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6642 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6644 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6645 if (c < 0)
6646 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6648 else
6649 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6652 if (it->dp
6653 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6654 VECTORP (dv)))
6656 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6658 /* Return the first character from the display table
6659 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6660 current character. */
6661 if (v->header.size)
6663 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6664 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6665 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6666 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6667 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6668 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6669 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6670 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6672 else
6674 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6676 goto get_next;
6679 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6681 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6682 goto done;
6683 /* Don't display this character. */
6684 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6685 goto get_next;
6688 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6689 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6690 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6692 if (c == 0xA0)
6693 nonascii_space_p = 1;
6694 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6695 nonascii_hyphen_p = 1;
6698 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6699 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6700 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6701 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6702 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6704 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6705 translated too.
6707 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6708 translated to octal form. */
6709 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6710 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6711 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6712 || (c != '\t'
6713 && it->glyph_row
6714 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6715 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6716 : (nonascii_space_p
6717 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6718 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6719 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6721 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6722 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6723 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6724 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6725 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6726 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6727 Lisp_Object gc;
6728 int ctl_len;
6729 int face_id;
6730 int lface_id = 0;
6731 int escape_glyph;
6733 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6735 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6737 int g;
6739 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6740 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6741 if (it->dp
6742 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6744 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6745 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6747 if (lface_id)
6749 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6751 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6752 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6754 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6756 else
6758 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6759 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6760 it->face_id);
6761 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6762 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6763 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6766 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6767 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6768 ctl_len = 2;
6769 goto display_control;
6772 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6773 highlighting. */
6775 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6777 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6778 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6779 it->face_id);
6780 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6781 ctl_len = 1;
6782 goto display_control;
6785 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6787 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6788 escape_glyph = '\\';
6790 if (it->dp
6791 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6793 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6794 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6796 if (lface_id)
6798 /* The display table specified a face.
6799 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6800 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6801 it->face_id);
6803 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6804 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6806 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6808 else
6810 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6811 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6812 it->face_id);
6813 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6814 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6815 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6818 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6820 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6822 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6823 ctl_len = 1;
6824 goto display_control;
6827 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6829 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6831 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6832 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6833 ctl_len = 2;
6834 goto display_control;
6838 char str[10];
6839 int len, i;
6841 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6842 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6843 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6844 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6846 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6847 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6848 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6849 ctl_len = len + 1;
6852 display_control:
6853 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6854 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6855 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6856 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6857 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6858 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6859 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6860 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6861 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6862 goto get_next;
6864 it->char_to_display = c;
6866 else if (success_p)
6868 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6872 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6873 character in unibyte text. */
6874 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6875 && it->multibyte_p
6876 && success_p
6877 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6879 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6881 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6883 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6884 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6886 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6888 else
6890 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6891 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6892 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6893 int c;
6895 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6896 c = it->char_to_display;
6897 else
6899 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6900 int i;
6902 c = ' ';
6903 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6904 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6905 padding space on the left or right. */
6906 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6907 break;
6909 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6913 done:
6914 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6915 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6916 if (it->face_box_p
6917 && it->s == NULL)
6919 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6921 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6922 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6924 if (face)
6926 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6928 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6929 display string, check faces in that string. */
6930 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6931 it->end_of_box_run_p
6932 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6933 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6935 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6936 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6937 the next buffer location. */
6938 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6939 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6940 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6942 ptrdiff_t ignore;
6943 int next_face_id;
6944 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6945 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6947 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6948 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6949 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6950 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6951 -1);
6952 it->end_of_box_run_p
6953 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6954 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6958 else
6960 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6961 it->end_of_box_run_p
6962 = (face_id != it->face_id
6963 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6966 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
6967 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
6968 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
6969 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
6970 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
6971 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
6973 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6974 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
6977 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6978 return success_p;
6982 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6984 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6985 skip to the next visible line start.
6987 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6988 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6989 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6990 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6991 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6992 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6993 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6994 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6995 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6997 void
6998 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
7000 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
7001 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
7002 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
7003 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
7005 switch (it->method)
7007 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
7008 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
7009 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
7010 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
7011 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
7012 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
7013 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7015 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
7016 int i;
7018 if (! it->bidi_p)
7020 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7021 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7022 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7024 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7026 else
7028 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7029 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7030 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7031 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
7034 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7036 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
7037 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
7038 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
7039 character visually after the current composition. */
7040 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7041 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7042 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7043 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7045 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7047 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7048 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7050 else
7052 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7053 Find the next stop position. */
7054 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7055 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7056 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7057 where to stop. */
7058 stop = -1;
7059 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7060 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7063 else
7065 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7066 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7067 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7068 character visually after the current composition. */
7069 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7070 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7071 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7072 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7073 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7075 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7076 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7078 else
7080 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7081 Find the next stop position. */
7082 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7083 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7084 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7085 where to stop. */
7086 stop = -1;
7087 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7088 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7092 else
7094 eassert (it->len != 0);
7096 if (!it->bidi_p)
7098 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7099 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7101 else
7103 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7104 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7105 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7106 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7107 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7108 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7109 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7110 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7111 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7113 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7114 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7115 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7116 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7117 stop = -1;
7118 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7119 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7122 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7124 break;
7126 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7127 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7128 if (!it->bidi_p
7129 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7130 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7131 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7132 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7133 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7135 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7136 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7138 else
7140 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7141 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7142 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7144 break;
7146 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7147 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7148 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7149 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7150 strings. */
7151 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7153 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7154 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7155 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7157 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7159 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7161 if (it->s)
7162 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7163 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7164 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7165 else
7167 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7168 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7171 it->dpvec = NULL;
7172 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7174 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7175 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7176 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7177 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7179 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7180 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7181 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
7182 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7183 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7186 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
7187 if (recheck_faces)
7188 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7190 break;
7192 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7193 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7194 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7195 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7196 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7197 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7198 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7199 stack. */
7200 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7202 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7203 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7204 where the string ends. */
7205 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7206 goto consider_string_end;
7208 else
7210 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7211 against it->end_charpos . */
7212 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7213 goto consider_string_end;
7215 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7217 int i;
7219 if (! it->bidi_p)
7221 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7222 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7223 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7224 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7225 else
7227 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7228 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7229 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7230 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7231 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7234 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7236 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7237 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7238 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7239 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7241 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7242 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7243 else
7245 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7246 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7247 stop = -1;
7248 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7249 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7250 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7251 it->string);
7254 else
7256 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7257 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7258 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7259 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7260 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7261 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7262 else
7264 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7265 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7266 stop = -1;
7267 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7268 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7269 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7270 it->string);
7274 else
7276 if (!it->bidi_p
7277 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7278 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7279 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7280 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7281 characters. */
7282 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7284 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7285 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7287 else
7289 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7291 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7292 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7293 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7294 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7296 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7298 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7299 stop = -1;
7300 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7301 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7302 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7303 it->string);
7308 consider_string_end:
7310 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7312 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7313 next, if there is one. */
7314 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7316 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7317 next_overlay_string (it);
7318 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7319 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7322 else
7324 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7325 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7326 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7327 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7328 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7329 && it->sp > 0)
7331 pop_it (it);
7332 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7333 goto consider_string_end;
7336 break;
7338 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7339 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7340 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7341 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7342 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7343 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7344 pop_it (it);
7345 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7346 goto consider_string_end;
7347 break;
7349 default:
7350 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7351 emacs_abort ();
7354 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7355 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7356 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7359 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7360 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7361 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7362 or `\003'.
7364 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7365 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7366 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7368 static int
7369 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7371 Lisp_Object gc;
7373 /* Precondition. */
7374 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7376 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7378 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7379 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7380 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7382 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7384 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7385 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7387 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7388 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7389 zero means no face is specified. */
7390 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7391 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7392 else
7394 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7395 if (lface_id > 0)
7396 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7397 it->saved_face_id);
7400 else
7401 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7402 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7404 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7405 still the values of the character that had this display table
7406 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7407 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7408 return 1;
7411 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7412 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7413 static void
7414 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7416 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7417 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7418 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7420 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7422 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7423 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7425 else
7427 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7428 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7431 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7433 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7434 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7435 call it. */
7436 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7438 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7439 || (!string_p
7440 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7441 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7443 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7444 the next element right away. */
7445 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7446 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7448 else
7450 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7452 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7453 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7454 next element. */
7455 if (string_p)
7456 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7457 else
7459 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7460 -1);
7461 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7463 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7466 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7467 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7468 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7470 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7471 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7474 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7475 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7477 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7478 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7480 else
7482 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7483 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7486 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7488 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7490 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7492 eassert (!it->s);
7493 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7494 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7495 stop = it->end_charpos;
7496 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7497 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7499 else
7501 stop = it->end_charpos;
7502 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7503 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7505 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7506 stop = -1;
7507 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7508 it->string);
7512 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7513 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7514 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7515 overlay string. */
7517 static int
7518 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7520 struct text_pos position;
7522 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7523 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7524 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7525 position = it->current.string_pos;
7527 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7528 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7529 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7530 direction is not known. */
7531 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7533 get_visually_first_element (it);
7534 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7537 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7538 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7540 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7542 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7543 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7544 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7546 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7547 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7548 with several other stop positions in between that we
7549 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7550 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7551 that precedes our current position. */
7552 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7553 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7555 else
7557 if (it->bidi_p)
7559 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7560 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7561 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7562 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7563 note of the last stop position seen at this
7564 level. */
7565 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7566 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7568 handle_stop (it);
7570 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7571 recurse here. */
7572 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7575 else if (it->bidi_p
7576 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7577 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7578 to handle that stop_pos. */
7579 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7580 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7581 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7582 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7583 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7584 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7586 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7587 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7588 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7589 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7590 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7591 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7592 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7593 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7594 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7598 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7600 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7601 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7602 do. */
7603 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7605 it->what = IT_EOB;
7606 return 0;
7608 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7609 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7610 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7611 ? -1
7612 : SCHARS (it->string))
7613 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7615 return 1;
7617 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7619 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7620 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7621 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7623 else
7625 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7626 it->len = 1;
7629 else
7631 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7632 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7633 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7634 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7635 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7637 it->what = IT_EOB;
7638 return 0;
7640 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7642 /* Pad with spaces. */
7643 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7644 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7646 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7647 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7648 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7649 ? -1
7650 : it->string_nchars)
7651 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7653 return 1;
7655 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7657 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7658 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7659 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7661 else
7663 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7664 it->len = 1;
7668 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7669 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7670 it->object = it->string;
7671 it->position = position;
7672 return 1;
7676 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7677 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7678 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7679 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7680 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7681 reached, including padding spaces. */
7683 static int
7684 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7686 int success_p = 1;
7688 eassert (it->s);
7689 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7690 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7691 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7692 it->object = Qnil;
7694 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7695 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7696 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7697 not known. */
7698 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7699 get_visually_first_element (it);
7701 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7702 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7703 initialized. */
7704 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7706 /* End of the game. */
7707 it->what = IT_EOB;
7708 success_p = 0;
7710 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7712 /* Pad with spaces. */
7713 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7714 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7716 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7717 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7718 else
7719 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7721 return success_p;
7725 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7726 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7727 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7728 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7730 static int
7731 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7733 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7734 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7735 else
7737 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7738 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7739 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7740 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7741 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7742 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7743 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7744 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7745 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7748 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7752 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7753 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7754 is always 1. */
7757 static int
7758 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7760 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7761 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7762 return 1;
7766 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7767 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7768 always 1. */
7770 static int
7771 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7773 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7774 return 1;
7777 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7778 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7779 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7780 reordering bidirectional text. */
7782 static void
7783 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7785 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7786 struct text_pos pos;
7787 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7788 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7789 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7790 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7791 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7792 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7794 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7795 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7796 it->bidi_p = 0;
7799 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7800 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7801 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7802 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7803 compute_stop_pos (it);
7804 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7805 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7806 emacs_abort ();
7808 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7810 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7811 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7812 else
7813 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7814 it->bidi_p = 1;
7815 it->current = save_current;
7816 it->position = save_position;
7817 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7818 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7821 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7822 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7823 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7824 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7825 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7826 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7827 position. */
7829 static void
7830 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7832 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7833 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7834 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7835 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7836 struct text_pos pos1;
7837 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7839 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7840 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7841 it->bidi_p = 0;
7844 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7845 if (bufp)
7847 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7848 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7850 else
7851 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7852 compute_stop_pos (it);
7853 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7854 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7855 emacs_abort ();
7856 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7858 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7860 it->bidi_p = 1;
7861 it->current = save_current;
7862 it->position = save_position;
7863 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7864 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7865 handle_stop (it);
7866 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7869 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7870 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7871 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7872 end. */
7874 static int
7875 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7877 int success_p = 1;
7879 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7880 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7881 eassert (!it->bidi_p
7882 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7883 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7885 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7886 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7887 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7888 a different paragraph. */
7889 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7891 get_visually_first_element (it);
7892 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7895 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7897 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7899 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7901 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7902 haven't been returned yet. */
7903 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7904 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7905 else
7907 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7908 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7911 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7912 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7913 else
7915 it->what = IT_EOB;
7916 it->position = it->current.pos;
7917 success_p = 0;
7920 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7921 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7922 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7924 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7925 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7926 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7927 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7928 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7929 current position. */
7930 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7931 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7933 else
7935 if (it->bidi_p)
7937 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7938 for when we will move back across it. */
7939 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7940 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7941 note of the last stop position seen at this
7942 level. */
7943 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7944 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7946 handle_stop (it);
7947 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7950 else if (it->bidi_p
7951 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7952 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7953 handle that stop_pos. */
7954 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7955 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7956 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7957 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7958 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7959 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7961 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7962 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7964 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7965 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7966 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7967 vertical-motion. */
7968 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7969 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7970 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7972 else
7973 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7974 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7976 else
7978 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7979 character from current_buffer. */
7980 unsigned char *p;
7981 ptrdiff_t stop;
7983 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7984 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7985 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7986 && it->glyph_row
7987 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7988 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7990 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7991 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7992 stop)
7993 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7995 return 1;
7998 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7999 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8000 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
8001 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
8002 else
8003 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
8005 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
8006 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
8007 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8008 it->position = it->current.pos;
8010 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
8011 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
8012 if (it->selective)
8014 if (it->c == '\n')
8016 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
8017 than that number of columns. */
8018 if (it->selective > 0
8019 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
8020 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
8021 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
8022 it->selective))
8024 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8025 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8028 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
8030 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
8031 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
8032 ellipsis displayed for it. */
8033 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8034 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8039 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
8040 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
8041 return success_p;
8045 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8047 static void
8048 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8050 Lisp_Object args[3];
8052 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8053 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8054 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8056 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8057 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8058 args[1] = it->window;
8059 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8060 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8062 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8063 them again, even if they get an error. */
8064 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8065 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8067 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8068 handle_face_prop (it);
8072 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8073 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8074 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8075 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8077 static int
8078 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8080 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8081 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8082 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8084 if (it->c < 0)
8086 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8087 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8088 return 0;
8090 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8091 it->object = it->string;
8092 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8093 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8095 else
8097 if (it->c < 0)
8099 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8100 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8101 if (it->bidi_p)
8103 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8104 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8105 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8106 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8107 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8108 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8110 return 0;
8112 it->position = it->current.pos;
8113 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8114 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8115 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8117 return 1;
8122 /***********************************************************************
8123 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8124 ***********************************************************************/
8126 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8127 position after some move_it_ call. */
8129 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8130 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8131 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8132 : 1)
8135 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8136 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8138 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8139 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8140 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8141 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8143 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8144 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8145 scroll amount.
8147 The return value has several possible values that
8148 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8150 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8151 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8153 MOVE_X_REACHED
8154 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8156 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8157 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8158 be continued.
8160 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8161 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8162 truncated.
8164 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8165 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8166 display is on. */
8168 static enum move_it_result
8169 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8170 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8171 enum move_operation_enum op)
8173 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8174 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8175 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8176 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8177 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8178 int may_wrap = 0;
8179 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8180 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8181 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8183 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8184 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8185 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8187 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8188 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8189 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8190 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8191 pixel positions. */
8192 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8193 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8194 atx_it.sp = -1;
8196 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8197 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8198 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8199 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8200 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8201 if (it->bidi_p)
8203 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8204 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8205 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8206 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8209 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8210 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8211 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8212 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8213 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8214 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8215 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8216 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8217 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8218 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8219 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8220 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8221 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8222 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8223 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8225 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8226 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8227 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8228 handle_line_prefix (it);
8230 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8231 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8233 while (1)
8235 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8237 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8238 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8239 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8240 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8242 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8243 display string or stretch glyph). */
8244 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8245 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8246 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8247 && (((!it->bidi_p
8248 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8249 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8250 display in strictly increasing order of their
8251 buffer positions. */
8252 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8253 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8254 || (it->bidi_p
8255 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8256 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8257 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8258 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8259 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8260 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8261 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8262 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8263 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8265 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8267 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8268 break;
8270 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8271 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8272 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8273 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8274 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8277 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8278 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8279 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8280 explicitly below. */
8281 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8283 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8284 break;
8287 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8289 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8291 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8292 break;
8295 else
8297 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8299 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8300 may_wrap = 1;
8301 else if (may_wrap)
8303 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8304 whitespace characters. If the position is
8305 already found, we are done. */
8306 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8308 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8309 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8310 goto done;
8312 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8314 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8315 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8316 goto done;
8318 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8319 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8320 may_wrap = 0;
8325 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8326 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8327 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8328 descent = it->max_descent;
8330 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8331 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8332 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8333 line. */
8334 x = it->current_x;
8336 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8338 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8340 prev_method = it->method;
8341 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8342 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8343 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8344 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8345 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8346 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8347 if (it->bidi_p
8348 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8349 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8350 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8351 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8352 continue;
8355 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8356 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8357 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8358 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8359 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8360 composite character.)
8362 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8363 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8364 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8365 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8366 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8367 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8368 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8369 next line.
8371 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8372 the same width. */
8373 if (it->nglyphs)
8375 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8376 glyphs have the same width. */
8377 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8378 int new_x;
8379 int x_before_this_char = x;
8380 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8382 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8384 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8386 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8387 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8389 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8391 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8392 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8393 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8395 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8396 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8399 else
8401 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8403 it->current_x = x;
8404 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8405 break;
8407 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8409 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8410 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8415 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8416 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8417 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8418 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8419 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8420 system frame. */
8421 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8422 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8423 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8424 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8425 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8427 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8428 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8429 it->hpos == 0
8430 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8431 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8433 ++it->hpos;
8434 it->current_x = new_x;
8436 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8437 in this row. */
8438 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8440 /* If this is the destination position,
8441 return a position *before* it in this row,
8442 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8443 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8445 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8446 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8448 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8449 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8450 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8451 break;
8453 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8454 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8456 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8457 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8458 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8462 prev_method = it->method;
8463 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8464 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8465 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8466 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8467 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8468 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8469 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8470 "overflow" into the fringe if
8471 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8472 On text terminals, and on graphical
8473 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8474 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8475 display line.*/
8476 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8477 || ((it->bidi_p
8478 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8479 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8480 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8481 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8483 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8485 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8486 break;
8488 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8490 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8491 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8492 else
8493 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8494 break;
8496 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8498 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8499 break;
8504 else
8505 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8507 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8509 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8510 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8511 atx_it.sp = -1;
8514 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8515 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8516 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8517 break;
8520 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8522 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8523 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8524 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8526 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8527 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8531 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8533 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8534 would be displayed. */
8535 ++it->hpos;
8539 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8540 break;
8542 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8544 buffer_pos_reached:
8545 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8546 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8547 break;
8549 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8551 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8552 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8553 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8554 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8555 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8556 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8557 break;
8560 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8561 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8563 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8564 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8565 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8566 did. */
8567 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8569 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8571 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8573 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8574 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8576 else
8577 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8579 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8580 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8581 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8582 else
8583 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8585 else
8586 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8587 break;
8590 prev_method = it->method;
8591 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8592 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8593 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8594 to the next. */
8595 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8596 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8597 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8598 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8599 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8600 if (it->bidi_p
8601 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8602 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8603 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8604 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8606 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8607 past the right edge of the window now. */
8608 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8609 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8611 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8612 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8613 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8614 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8615 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8617 int at_eob_p = 0;
8619 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8620 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8621 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8622 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8623 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8624 unidirectional display did. */
8625 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8626 && !saw_smaller_pos
8627 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8629 if (it->bidi_p
8630 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8631 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8632 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8633 break;
8635 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8637 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8638 break;
8641 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8642 && !saw_smaller_pos
8643 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8645 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8646 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8647 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8648 break;
8650 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8651 break;
8653 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8656 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8658 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8659 restore the saved iterator. */
8660 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8661 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8662 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8663 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8665 done:
8667 if (atpos_data)
8668 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8669 if (atx_data)
8670 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8671 if (wrap_data)
8672 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8673 if (ppos_data)
8674 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8676 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8677 function. */
8678 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8679 return result;
8682 /* For external use. */
8683 void
8684 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8685 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8686 enum move_operation_enum op)
8688 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8689 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8691 struct it save_it;
8692 void *save_data = NULL;
8693 int skip;
8695 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8696 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8697 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8698 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8699 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8700 space before the wrap point. */
8701 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8703 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8704 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8705 move_it_in_display_line_to
8706 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8708 else
8709 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8711 else
8712 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8716 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8717 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8719 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8720 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8721 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8723 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8724 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8725 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8727 void
8728 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8730 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8731 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8732 void *backup_data = NULL;
8734 for (;;)
8736 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8738 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8739 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8740 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8742 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8744 reached = 1;
8745 break;
8747 else
8748 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8750 else
8752 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8753 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8754 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8756 reached = 2;
8757 break;
8760 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8762 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8764 reached = 3;
8765 break;
8767 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8769 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8770 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8771 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8772 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8774 reached = 4;
8775 break;
8780 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8782 struct it it_backup;
8784 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8785 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8787 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8788 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8789 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8790 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8791 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8792 TO_X.
8794 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8795 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8796 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8797 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8798 to happen. */
8799 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8800 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8801 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8803 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8804 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8805 reached = 5;
8806 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8808 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8809 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8810 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8811 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8812 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8813 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8814 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8816 reached = 6;
8817 break;
8819 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8820 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8821 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8822 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8823 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8824 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8825 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8827 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8828 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8830 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8831 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8832 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8833 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8834 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8835 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8836 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8837 height. */
8838 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8839 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8841 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8842 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8843 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8844 reached = 6;
8846 else
8848 skip = skip2;
8849 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8850 reached = 7;
8853 else
8855 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8856 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8857 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8859 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8860 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8862 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8863 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8864 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8865 space before the wrap point. */
8866 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8867 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8869 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8870 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8871 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8872 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8874 reached = 6;
8878 if (reached)
8879 break;
8881 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8882 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8883 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8884 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8885 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8886 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8887 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8888 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8889 chance below. */
8890 && !(it->bidi_p
8891 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8892 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8893 else
8894 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8896 switch (skip)
8898 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8899 reached = 8;
8900 goto out;
8902 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8903 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8904 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8905 break;
8907 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8908 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8909 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8910 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8911 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8913 reached = 9;
8914 goto out;
8916 break;
8918 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8919 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8920 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8921 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8922 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8923 if (it->c == '\t')
8925 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8926 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8927 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8928 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8929 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8930 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8931 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8933 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8934 - it->last_visible_x;
8935 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8938 else
8939 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8940 break;
8942 default:
8943 emacs_abort ();
8946 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8947 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8948 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8949 line_start_x = 0;
8950 it->hpos = 0;
8951 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8952 ++it->vpos;
8953 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8954 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8955 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8958 out:
8960 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8961 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8962 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8963 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8964 that brings us offscreen). */
8965 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8966 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8967 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8968 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8969 && it->nglyphs > 1
8970 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8971 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8972 && it->c != '\n'
8973 && it->c != '\t'
8974 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8976 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8977 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8978 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8979 ++it->vpos;
8980 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8981 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8984 if (backup_data)
8985 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8987 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8991 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8993 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8994 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8995 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8996 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8997 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8999 void
9000 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
9002 int nlines, h;
9003 struct it it2, it3;
9004 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
9005 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
9007 move_further_back:
9008 eassert (dy >= 0);
9010 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9012 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
9013 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
9015 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
9016 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9017 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9019 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
9020 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
9021 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
9022 use reseat_1 here. */
9023 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9025 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
9026 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
9027 reordering is in effect. */
9028 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9030 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
9031 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
9032 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
9033 y-distance. */
9034 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9035 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
9038 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
9039 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9041 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9042 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9043 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9044 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9045 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9046 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9047 START_POS and will not move. */
9048 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9049 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9050 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9051 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9052 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9054 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9055 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9056 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9057 and the starting position. */
9058 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9059 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9060 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9062 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9063 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9064 it->vpos -= nlines;
9065 it->current_y -= h;
9067 if (dy == 0)
9069 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9070 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9071 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9072 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9073 if (nlines > 0)
9074 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9075 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9076 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9077 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9078 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9079 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9080 line. */
9081 if (it->bidi_p
9082 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9083 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9084 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9085 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9087 ptrdiff_t nl_pos =
9088 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
9090 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9092 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9094 else
9096 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9097 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9098 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9099 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9100 int y1;
9101 int line_height;
9103 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9104 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9105 line_height = y1 - y0;
9106 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9107 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9108 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9109 if (target_y < it->current_y
9110 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9111 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9112 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9113 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9114 && (it->current_y - target_y
9115 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9116 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9118 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9119 target_y - it->current_y));
9120 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9121 goto move_further_back;
9123 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9124 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9126 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9128 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9129 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9130 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9131 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9132 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9134 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9135 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9136 else
9140 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9142 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9149 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9150 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9151 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9153 void
9154 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9156 if (dy <= 0)
9157 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9158 else
9160 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9161 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9162 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9163 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9165 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9166 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9167 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9168 && ZV > BEGV
9169 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9170 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9175 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9177 void
9178 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9180 enum move_it_result rc;
9182 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9183 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9184 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9188 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9189 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9190 screen line.
9192 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9193 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9194 truncate-lines nil. */
9196 void
9197 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9200 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9201 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9202 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9203 /* struct position pos;
9204 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9206 struct text_pos textpos;
9208 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9209 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9210 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9211 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9212 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9214 else */
9216 if (dvpos == 0)
9218 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9219 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9220 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
9221 last_height = 0;
9223 else if (dvpos > 0)
9225 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9226 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9228 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9229 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9230 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9231 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9232 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9233 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9234 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9235 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9236 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9237 correctly. */
9238 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9239 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9242 else
9244 struct it it2;
9245 void *it2data = NULL;
9246 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9248 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9249 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9250 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9251 dvpos += it->vpos;
9252 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9253 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9255 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
9256 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9257 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
9258 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9259 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9261 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9262 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9264 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9265 dvpos += it->vpos;
9266 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9267 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9268 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9269 break;
9270 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9271 move further back. */
9272 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9273 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9274 dvpos--;
9277 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9279 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9280 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9281 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9282 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9283 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9284 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9285 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9286 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9288 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9289 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9291 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9293 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9294 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9295 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9296 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9297 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9298 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9299 else
9300 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9302 else
9303 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9307 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9310 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9312 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9313 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9314 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9318 /***********************************************************************
9319 Messages
9320 ***********************************************************************/
9323 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9324 to *Messages*. */
9326 void
9327 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9329 Lisp_Object args[3];
9330 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9331 char *buffer;
9332 ptrdiff_t len;
9333 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9334 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9336 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9337 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9339 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9340 args[1] = arg1;
9341 args[2] = arg2;
9342 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9344 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9345 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9346 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9348 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9349 SAFE_FREE ();
9351 UNGCPRO;
9355 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9357 void
9358 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9360 if (message_log_need_newline)
9361 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9365 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9366 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9367 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9368 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9369 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9371 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9372 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9374 void
9375 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9377 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9379 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9380 return;
9382 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9384 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9385 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9386 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9387 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9388 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9389 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9390 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9392 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9393 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9394 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9395 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9397 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9398 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9399 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9400 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9401 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9402 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9403 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9405 if (PT == Z)
9406 point_at_end = 1;
9407 if (ZV == Z)
9408 zv_at_end = 1;
9410 BEGV = BEG;
9411 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9412 ZV = Z;
9413 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9414 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9416 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9417 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9418 if (multibyte
9419 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9421 ptrdiff_t i;
9422 int c, char_bytes;
9423 char work[1];
9425 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9426 for the *Message* buffer. */
9427 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9429 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9430 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9432 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9433 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9436 else if (! multibyte
9437 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9439 ptrdiff_t i;
9440 int c, char_bytes;
9441 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9442 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9443 for the *Message* buffer. */
9444 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9446 c = msg[i];
9447 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9448 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9449 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9452 else if (nbytes)
9453 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9455 if (nlflag)
9457 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9458 printmax_t dups;
9459 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9461 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9462 this_bol = PT;
9463 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9465 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9466 If so, combine duplicates. */
9467 if (this_bol > BEG)
9469 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9470 prev_bol = PT;
9471 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9473 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9474 this_bol_byte);
9475 if (dups)
9477 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9478 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9479 if (dups > 1)
9481 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9482 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9484 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9485 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9486 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9487 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9488 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9493 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9494 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9495 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9497 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9499 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9500 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9501 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9504 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9505 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9507 if (zv_at_end)
9509 ZV = Z;
9510 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9512 else
9514 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9515 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9518 if (point_at_end)
9519 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9520 else
9521 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9522 Lisp code. */
9523 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9524 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9526 UNGCPRO;
9527 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9528 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9529 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9531 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9532 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9533 if (NILP (tem))
9534 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9535 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9536 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9541 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9542 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9543 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9544 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9545 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9547 static intmax_t
9548 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9550 ptrdiff_t i;
9551 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9552 int seen_dots = 0;
9553 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9554 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9556 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9558 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9559 seen_dots = 1;
9560 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9561 return seen_dots;
9563 p1 += len;
9564 if (*p1 == '\n')
9565 return 2;
9566 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9568 char *pend;
9569 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9570 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9571 return n+1;
9573 return 0;
9577 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9578 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9579 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9580 through.
9582 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9584 void
9585 message2 (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9587 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9588 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9589 if (m)
9590 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9591 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9595 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9597 void
9598 message2_nolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9600 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9601 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9603 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9605 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9606 putc ('\n', stderr);
9607 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9608 if (m)
9609 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9610 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9611 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9612 fflush (stderr);
9614 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9615 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9616 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9617 else if (INTERACTIVE
9618 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9619 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9621 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9622 struct frame *f;
9624 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9625 that the selected frame is using. */
9626 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9627 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9629 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9630 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9631 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9632 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9634 if (m)
9636 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9637 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9638 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9640 else
9641 clear_message (1, 1);
9643 do_pending_window_change (0);
9644 echo_area_display (1);
9645 do_pending_window_change (0);
9646 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9647 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9652 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9653 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9654 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9655 text show through.
9657 This function cancels echoing. */
9659 void
9660 message3 (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9662 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9664 GCPRO1 (m);
9665 clear_message (1,1);
9666 cancel_echoing ();
9668 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9669 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9670 if (STRINGP (m))
9672 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9673 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9674 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9675 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9676 SAFE_FREE ();
9678 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9680 UNGCPRO;
9684 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9685 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9686 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9687 and make this cancel echoing. */
9689 void
9690 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9692 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9693 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9695 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9697 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9698 putc ('\n', stderr);
9699 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9700 if (STRINGP (m))
9701 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9702 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9703 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9704 fflush (stderr);
9706 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9707 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9708 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9709 else if (INTERACTIVE
9710 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9711 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9713 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9714 Lisp_Object frame;
9715 struct frame *f;
9717 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9718 that the selected frame is using. */
9719 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9720 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9721 f = XFRAME (frame);
9723 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9724 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9725 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9726 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9728 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9730 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9731 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9732 Fraise_frame (frame);
9733 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9734 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9735 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9737 else
9738 clear_message (1, 1);
9740 do_pending_window_change (0);
9741 echo_area_display (1);
9742 do_pending_window_change (0);
9743 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9744 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9749 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9750 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9752 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9753 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9754 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9755 that was alloca'd. */
9757 void
9758 message1 (const char *m)
9760 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9764 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9766 void
9767 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9769 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9772 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9773 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9775 void
9776 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9778 CHECK_STRING (string);
9780 if (noninteractive)
9782 if (m)
9784 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9785 putc ('\n', stderr);
9786 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9787 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9788 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9789 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9790 fflush (stderr);
9793 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9795 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9796 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9797 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9798 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9799 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9801 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9802 that the selected frame is using. */
9803 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9804 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9806 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9807 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9808 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9809 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9811 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9812 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9814 args[0] = build_string (m);
9815 args[1] = msg = string;
9816 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9817 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9819 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9821 if (log)
9822 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9823 else
9824 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9826 UNGCPRO;
9828 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9829 buffer next time. */
9830 message_buf_print = 0;
9836 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9837 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9839 static void
9840 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9842 if (noninteractive)
9844 if (m)
9846 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9847 putc ('\n', stderr);
9848 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9849 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9850 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9851 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9852 fflush (stderr);
9855 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9857 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9858 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9859 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9860 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9861 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9863 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9864 that the selected frame is using. */
9865 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9866 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9868 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9869 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9870 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9871 it. */
9872 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9874 if (m)
9876 ptrdiff_t len;
9878 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9879 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9881 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 1);
9883 else
9884 message1 (0);
9886 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9887 buffer next time. */
9888 message_buf_print = 0;
9893 void
9894 message (const char *m, ...)
9896 va_list ap;
9897 va_start (ap, m);
9898 vmessage (m, ap);
9899 va_end (ap);
9903 #if 0
9904 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9906 void
9907 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9909 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9910 va_list ap;
9911 va_start (ap, m);
9912 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9913 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9914 vmessage (m, ap);
9915 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9916 va_end (ap);
9918 #endif
9921 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9922 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9923 critical. */
9925 void
9926 update_echo_area (void)
9928 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9930 Lisp_Object string;
9931 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9932 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9933 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9938 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9939 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9941 static void
9942 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9944 int i;
9946 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9947 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9948 || !BUFFER_LIVE_P (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])))
9950 char name[30];
9951 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9952 int j;
9954 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9955 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
9956 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
9957 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
9958 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9959 it was decided to postpone this*/
9960 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9962 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9963 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9964 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9969 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9970 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9972 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9973 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9974 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9976 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9977 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9979 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9980 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9981 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9983 Value is what FN returns. */
9985 static int
9986 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9987 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
9988 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
9990 Lisp_Object buffer;
9991 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9992 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9994 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9995 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9997 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9999 if (which == 0)
10000 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10001 else if (which > 0)
10002 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
10003 else
10005 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10006 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10008 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
10009 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
10010 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
10011 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
10012 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
10015 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
10016 have one. */
10017 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
10019 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
10020 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
10021 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
10022 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
10023 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10026 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
10028 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
10029 for a different purpose. */
10030 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
10031 cancel_echoing ();
10033 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
10034 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
10036 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10037 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10038 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10039 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10040 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10041 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10042 aborts. */
10043 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10044 if (w)
10046 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10047 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10050 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10051 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10052 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10053 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10055 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10056 del_range (BEG, Z);
10058 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10059 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10061 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
10063 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10064 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10066 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10067 return rc;
10071 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10072 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10074 static Lisp_Object
10075 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10077 int i = 0;
10078 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10080 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10081 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10082 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10083 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10085 if (NILP (vector))
10086 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
10088 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10089 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10090 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10092 if (w)
10094 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10095 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
10096 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
10097 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
10099 else
10101 int end = i + 4;
10102 for (; i < end; ++i)
10103 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10106 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10107 return vector;
10111 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10112 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10114 static Lisp_Object
10115 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10117 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10118 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10119 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10121 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10123 struct window *w;
10124 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
10126 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10127 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10128 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
10129 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
10131 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10132 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10133 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
10136 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10137 return Qnil;
10141 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10142 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10144 void
10145 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10147 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10148 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10149 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10151 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10153 if (!message_buf_print)
10155 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10156 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10157 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10158 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10159 else
10160 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10162 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10163 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10164 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10166 if (Z > BEG)
10168 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10169 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10170 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10171 del_range (BEG, Z);
10172 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10174 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10176 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10177 if (multibyte_p
10178 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10179 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10181 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10182 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10184 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10185 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10186 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10187 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10190 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10191 message_buf_print = 1;
10193 else
10195 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10197 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10198 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10199 else
10200 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10203 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10205 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10206 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10207 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10213 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10214 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10215 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10216 display the current message. */
10218 static int
10219 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10221 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10223 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10224 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10225 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10226 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10227 redisplay. */
10228 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10230 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10231 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10232 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10233 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10234 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10235 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10237 window_height_changed_p
10238 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10239 display_echo_area_1,
10240 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
10242 if (no_message_p)
10243 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10245 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10246 return window_height_changed_p;
10250 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10251 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10252 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10253 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10254 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10256 static int
10257 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10259 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10260 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10261 Lisp_Object window;
10262 struct text_pos start;
10263 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10265 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10266 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10267 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10268 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10270 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10271 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10273 /* Display. */
10274 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10275 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10276 try_window (window, start, 0);
10278 return window_height_changed_p;
10282 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10283 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10284 is active, don't shrink it. */
10286 void
10287 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10289 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10290 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10292 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10293 int resized_p;
10294 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
10296 if (minibuf_level == 0)
10297 resize_exactly = Qt;
10298 else
10299 resize_exactly = Qnil;
10301 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10302 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
10303 0, 0);
10304 if (resized_p)
10306 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10307 ++update_mode_lines;
10308 redisplay_internal ();
10314 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10315 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10316 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10317 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10318 resize_mini_window returns. */
10320 static int
10321 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10323 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10324 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10328 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10329 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10330 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10332 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10333 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10334 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10335 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10337 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10340 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10342 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10343 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10345 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10347 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10348 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10349 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10350 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10352 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10353 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10354 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10355 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10356 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10357 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10358 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10359 return 0;
10361 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10362 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10363 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10364 return 0;
10366 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10368 struct it it;
10369 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10370 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10371 int height;
10372 EMACS_INT max_height;
10373 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10374 struct text_pos start;
10375 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10377 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10379 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10380 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10383 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10385 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10386 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10387 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10388 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10389 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10390 else
10391 max_height = total_height / 4;
10393 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10394 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10395 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10397 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10398 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10399 height = 1;
10400 else
10402 last_height = 0;
10403 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10404 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10405 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10406 else
10407 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10408 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10409 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10412 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10413 if (height > max_height)
10415 height = max_height;
10416 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10417 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10418 start = it.current.pos;
10420 else
10421 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10422 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10424 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10426 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10427 case the window shrinks again. */
10428 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10430 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10431 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10432 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10433 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10435 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10436 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10438 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10439 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10440 shrink_mini_window (w);
10441 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10444 else
10446 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10447 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10449 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10450 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10451 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10452 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10454 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10456 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10457 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10458 shrink_mini_window (w);
10460 if (height)
10462 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10463 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10466 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10470 if (old_current_buffer)
10471 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10474 return window_height_changed_p;
10478 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10479 current message. */
10481 Lisp_Object
10482 current_message (void)
10484 Lisp_Object msg;
10486 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10487 msg = Qnil;
10488 else
10490 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10491 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10492 if (NILP (msg))
10493 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10496 return msg;
10500 static int
10501 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10503 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10504 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10506 if (Z > BEG)
10507 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10508 else
10509 *msg = Qnil;
10510 return 0;
10514 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10515 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10516 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10517 worth optimizing. */
10519 bool
10520 push_message (void)
10522 Lisp_Object msg = current_message ();
10523 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10524 return STRINGP (msg);
10528 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10530 void
10531 restore_message (void)
10533 Lisp_Object msg;
10535 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10536 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10537 if (STRINGP (msg))
10538 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10539 else
10540 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10544 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10546 Lisp_Object
10547 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10549 pop_message ();
10550 return Qnil;
10553 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10555 static void
10556 pop_message (void)
10558 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10559 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10563 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10564 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10565 somewhere. */
10567 void
10568 check_message_stack (void)
10570 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10571 emacs_abort ();
10575 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10576 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10578 void
10579 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10581 if (nchars == 0)
10582 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10583 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10584 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10585 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10586 else if (!noninteractive
10587 && INTERACTIVE
10588 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10590 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10591 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10592 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10597 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10598 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10600 static int
10601 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10603 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10604 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10605 if (Z == BEG)
10606 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10607 return 0;
10610 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10612 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10613 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10614 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10616 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10617 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10618 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10620 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10621 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10624 static void
10625 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10626 ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10628 message_enable_multibyte
10629 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10630 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10632 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10633 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10634 message_buf_print = 0;
10635 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10637 if (STRINGP (Vdebug_on_message)
10638 && fast_string_match (Vdebug_on_message, string) >= 0)
10639 call_debugger (list2 (Qerror, string));
10643 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10644 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10645 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10646 current. */
10648 static int
10649 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t nbytes, ptrdiff_t multibyte_p)
10651 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10652 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10653 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10654 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10656 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10657 if (message_enable_multibyte
10658 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10659 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10661 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10662 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10663 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10665 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10666 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10668 if (STRINGP (string))
10670 ptrdiff_t nchars;
10672 if (nbytes == 0)
10673 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10674 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10676 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10677 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10678 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10679 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10681 else if (s)
10683 if (nbytes == 0)
10684 nbytes = strlen (s);
10686 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10688 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10689 ptrdiff_t i;
10690 int c, n;
10691 char work[1];
10693 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10694 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10696 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10697 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10699 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10700 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10703 else if (!multibyte_p
10704 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10706 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10707 ptrdiff_t i;
10708 int c, n;
10709 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10711 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10712 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10714 c = msg[i];
10715 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10716 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10717 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10720 else
10721 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10724 return 0;
10728 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10729 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10730 last displayed. */
10732 void
10733 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10735 if (current_p)
10737 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10738 message_cleared_p = 1;
10741 if (last_displayed_p)
10742 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10744 message_buf_print = 0;
10747 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10749 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10750 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10751 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10752 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10753 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10754 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10756 static void
10757 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10759 if (frame_garbaged)
10761 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10762 int changed_count = 0;
10764 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10766 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10768 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10770 if (f->resized_p)
10772 Fredraw_frame (frame);
10773 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10775 clear_current_matrices (f);
10776 changed_count++;
10777 f->garbaged = 0;
10778 f->resized_p = 0;
10782 frame_garbaged = 0;
10783 if (changed_count)
10784 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10789 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10790 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10791 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10793 static int
10794 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10796 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10797 struct window *w;
10798 struct frame *f;
10799 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10800 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10802 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10803 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10804 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10806 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10807 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10808 return 0;
10810 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10811 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10812 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10813 the terminal. */
10814 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10815 return 0;
10816 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10818 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10819 if (frame_garbaged)
10820 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10822 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10824 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10825 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10826 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10828 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10829 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10830 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10831 here could cause confusion. */
10832 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10834 int n = 0;
10836 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10837 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10838 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10839 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10840 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10841 if (!display_completed)
10842 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10844 if (window_height_changed_p
10845 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10846 needs to run hooks. */
10847 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10849 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10850 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10851 pending input. */
10852 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10853 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10854 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10855 redisplay_internal ();
10856 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10858 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10860 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10861 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10862 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10863 update_single_window (w, 1);
10864 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10866 else
10867 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10869 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10870 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10871 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10872 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10873 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10876 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10877 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10879 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10880 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10881 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10882 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10884 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10885 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10886 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10887 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10888 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10890 return window_height_changed_p;
10895 /***********************************************************************
10896 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10897 ***********************************************************************/
10899 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10900 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10901 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10903 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10905 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10907 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10908 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10910 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10911 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10913 static enum {
10914 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10915 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10916 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10917 MODE_LINE_STRING
10918 } mode_line_target;
10920 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10921 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10922 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10924 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10925 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10927 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10928 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10929 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10932 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10934 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10936 static Lisp_Object
10937 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
10938 struct buffer *obuf,
10939 Lisp_Object owin,
10940 int save_proptrans)
10942 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10944 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10945 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10946 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10947 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10949 if (NILP (vector))
10950 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
10952 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10953 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10954 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10955 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10956 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
10957 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
10959 if (obuf)
10960 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
10961 else
10962 tmp = Qnil;
10963 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
10964 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
10965 if (target_frame)
10967 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
10968 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
10969 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
10970 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
10971 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
10972 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
10975 return vector;
10978 static Lisp_Object
10979 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
10981 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
10982 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
10983 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
10985 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
10986 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
10987 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
10988 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
10989 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
10990 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
10991 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
10993 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
10994 if (!NILP (old_window))
10996 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
10997 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
10998 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
10999 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
11001 Lisp_Object frame
11002 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
11004 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
11005 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
11007 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
11008 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
11011 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
11014 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
11016 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
11017 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
11020 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
11021 return Qnil;
11025 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
11026 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
11028 static void
11029 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
11031 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
11032 increase the buffer's size. */
11033 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
11035 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11036 ptrdiff_t size = len;
11037 mode_line_noprop_buf =
11038 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11039 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11040 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11043 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11047 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11048 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11049 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11050 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11051 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11052 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11053 frame title. */
11055 static int
11056 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11058 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11059 int n = 0;
11060 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11062 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11063 nbytes = strlen (string);
11064 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11065 while (nbytes--)
11066 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11068 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11069 while (field_width > 0
11070 && n < field_width)
11072 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11073 ++n;
11076 return n;
11079 /***********************************************************************
11080 Frame Titles
11081 ***********************************************************************/
11083 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11085 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11086 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11087 frame_title_format. */
11089 static void
11090 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11092 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11094 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11095 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11096 || f->explicit_name)
11098 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11099 Lisp_Object tail;
11100 Lisp_Object fmt;
11101 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11102 char *title;
11103 ptrdiff_t len;
11104 struct it it;
11105 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11107 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
11109 Lisp_Object other_frame = XCAR (tail);
11110 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11112 if (tf != f
11113 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11114 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11115 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11116 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11117 break;
11120 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11121 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11123 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11124 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11125 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11126 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11127 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11128 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11130 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11131 set_buffer_internal_1
11132 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11133 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11135 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11136 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11137 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11138 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11139 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11140 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11141 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11142 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11144 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11145 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11146 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11147 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11148 higher level than this.) */
11149 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11150 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11151 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11152 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11156 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11159 /***********************************************************************
11160 Menu Bars
11161 ***********************************************************************/
11164 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11165 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11167 void
11168 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11170 int all_windows;
11171 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11172 struct frame *f;
11173 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11175 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11176 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11177 #else
11178 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11179 #endif
11181 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11182 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11183 up-to-date frame titles. */
11184 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11185 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
11187 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11189 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11191 f = XFRAME (frame);
11192 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11193 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
11194 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11197 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11199 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11200 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11201 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
11202 || buffer_shared > 1
11203 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
11204 if (all_windows)
11206 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11207 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11208 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11209 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11210 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11212 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11214 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11216 f = XFRAME (frame);
11218 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11219 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11220 continue;
11222 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11223 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11224 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11226 Lisp_Object functions;
11228 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11229 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11230 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11231 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11233 while (CONSP (functions))
11235 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11236 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11237 functions = XCDR (functions);
11239 UNGCPRO;
11242 GCPRO1 (tail);
11243 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11244 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11245 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11246 #endif
11247 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11248 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11249 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11250 ns_set_doc_edited
11251 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11252 #endif
11253 UNGCPRO;
11256 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11258 else
11260 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11261 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11262 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11263 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11264 #endif
11269 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11270 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11271 eval.
11273 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11275 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11276 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11277 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11278 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11280 static int
11281 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11283 Lisp_Object window;
11284 register struct window *w;
11286 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11287 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11288 redisplay. */
11289 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11290 return hooks_run;
11292 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11293 w = XWINDOW (window);
11295 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11297 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11298 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11299 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11300 #else
11301 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11302 #endif
11303 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11305 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11306 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11307 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11308 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11309 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11310 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11311 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11312 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11313 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11314 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11315 || update_mode_lines
11316 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11317 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11318 != w->last_had_star)
11319 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11320 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11321 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11323 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11324 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11326 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11328 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11329 if (save_match_data)
11330 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11331 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11333 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11334 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11337 if (!hooks_run)
11339 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11340 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11342 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11343 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11344 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11345 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11347 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11349 hooks_run = 1;
11352 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11353 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11355 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11356 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11357 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11358 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11360 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11361 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11362 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11363 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11364 #endif
11365 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11367 else
11368 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11369 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11370 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11371 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11372 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11373 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11374 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11375 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11377 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11378 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11382 return hooks_run;
11387 /***********************************************************************
11388 Output Cursor
11389 ***********************************************************************/
11391 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11393 /* EXPORT:
11394 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11395 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11396 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11398 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11401 /* EXPORT:
11402 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11403 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11405 void
11406 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11408 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11409 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11410 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11411 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11415 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11416 Set a nominal cursor position.
11418 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11419 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11421 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11422 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11423 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11424 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11426 void
11427 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11429 struct window *w;
11431 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11432 if (updated_window)
11433 w = updated_window;
11434 else
11435 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11437 /* Set the output cursor. */
11438 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11439 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11440 output_cursor.x = x;
11441 output_cursor.y = y;
11443 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11444 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11445 if (updated_window == NULL)
11447 block_input ();
11448 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11449 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11450 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11451 unblock_input ();
11455 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11458 /***********************************************************************
11459 Tool-bars
11460 ***********************************************************************/
11462 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11464 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11466 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11468 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11469 or -1. */
11471 int last_tool_bar_item;
11474 static Lisp_Object
11475 update_tool_bar_unwind (Lisp_Object frame)
11477 selected_frame = frame;
11478 return Qnil;
11481 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11482 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11483 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11484 and restore it here. */
11486 static void
11487 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11489 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11490 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11491 #else
11492 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11493 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11494 #endif
11496 if (do_update)
11498 Lisp_Object window;
11499 struct window *w;
11501 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11502 w = XWINDOW (window);
11504 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11505 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11506 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11507 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11508 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11509 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11510 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11511 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11512 || w->update_mode_line
11513 || update_mode_lines
11514 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11515 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11516 != w->last_had_star)
11517 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11518 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11519 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11521 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11522 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11523 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11524 int new_n_tool_bar;
11525 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11527 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11528 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11529 keymaps. */
11530 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11532 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11533 if (save_match_data)
11534 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11536 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11537 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11539 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11540 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11543 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11545 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11546 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11547 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11548 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11549 record_unwind_protect (update_tool_bar_unwind, selected_frame);
11550 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11551 selected_frame = frame;
11553 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11554 new_tool_bar
11555 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11556 &new_n_tool_bar);
11558 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11559 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11560 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11562 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11563 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11564 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11565 block_input ();
11566 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11567 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11568 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11569 unblock_input ();
11572 UNGCPRO;
11574 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11575 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11581 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11582 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11583 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11585 static void
11586 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11588 int i, size, size_needed;
11589 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11590 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11592 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11593 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11595 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11596 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11598 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11599 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11600 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11601 : 0);
11603 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11604 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11606 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11607 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11608 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11609 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11610 else
11612 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11613 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11614 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11617 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11618 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11619 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11620 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11622 #define PROP(IDX) \
11623 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11625 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11626 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11627 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11629 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11630 button state. */
11631 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11632 if (VECTORP (image))
11634 if (enabled_p)
11635 idx = (selected_p
11636 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11637 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11638 else
11639 idx = (selected_p
11640 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11641 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11643 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11644 image = AREF (image, idx);
11646 else
11647 idx = -1;
11649 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11650 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11651 continue;
11653 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11654 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11656 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11657 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11658 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11659 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11660 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11662 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11663 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11665 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11666 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11668 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11670 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11671 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11672 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11674 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11675 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11676 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11679 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11681 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11682 selected. */
11683 if (selected_p)
11685 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11686 hmargin -= relief;
11687 vmargin -= relief;
11690 else
11692 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11693 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11694 raised relief. */
11695 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11696 (selected_p
11697 ? make_number (-relief)
11698 : make_number (relief)));
11699 hmargin -= relief;
11700 vmargin -= relief;
11703 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11704 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11706 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11707 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11708 else
11709 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11710 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11711 make_number (vmargin)));
11714 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11715 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11716 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11717 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11718 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11720 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11721 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11722 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11723 vector. */
11724 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11725 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11726 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11728 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11729 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11730 previous string. */
11731 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11732 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11733 else
11734 end = i + 1;
11735 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11736 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11737 #undef PROP
11740 UNGCPRO;
11744 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11746 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11747 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11748 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11749 vertically in the new height.
11751 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11752 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11753 the window width.
11756 static void
11757 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11759 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11760 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11761 struct glyph *last;
11763 prepare_desired_row (row);
11764 row->y = it->current_y;
11766 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11767 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11768 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11770 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11772 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11773 struct it it_before;
11775 /* Get the next display element. */
11776 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11778 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11779 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11780 return;
11781 break;
11784 /* Produce glyphs. */
11785 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11786 it_before = *it;
11788 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11790 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11791 i = 0;
11792 x = it_before.current_x;
11793 while (i < nglyphs)
11795 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11797 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11799 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11800 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11801 *it = it_before;
11802 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11803 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11804 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11805 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11806 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11807 break;
11808 goto out;
11811 ++it->hpos;
11812 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11813 ++i;
11816 /* Stop at line end. */
11817 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11818 break;
11820 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11823 out:;
11825 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11827 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11829 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11830 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11831 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11832 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11833 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11834 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11836 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11837 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11838 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11839 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11840 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11842 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11843 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11845 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11846 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11847 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11848 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11851 compute_line_metrics (it);
11853 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11854 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11856 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11857 row->visible_height = row->height;
11858 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11859 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11862 row->full_width_p = 1;
11863 row->continued_p = 0;
11864 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11865 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11867 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11868 it->current_y += row->height;
11869 ++it->vpos;
11870 ++it->glyph_row;
11874 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11876 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11877 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11879 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11880 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11881 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11883 static int
11884 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11886 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11887 struct it it;
11888 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11889 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11890 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11891 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11893 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11894 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11895 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11896 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11897 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11898 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11899 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11901 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11903 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11904 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11905 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11907 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11909 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11910 if (n_rows)
11911 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11913 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11917 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11918 0, 1, 0,
11919 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME. */)
11920 (Lisp_Object frame)
11922 struct frame *f;
11923 struct window *w;
11924 int nlines = 0;
11926 if (NILP (frame))
11927 frame = selected_frame;
11928 else
11929 CHECK_FRAME (frame);
11930 f = XFRAME (frame);
11932 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11933 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11934 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11936 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11937 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11939 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11940 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11944 return make_number (nlines);
11948 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11949 height should be changed. */
11951 static int
11952 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11954 struct window *w;
11955 struct it it;
11956 struct glyph_row *row;
11958 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11959 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11960 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11961 return 0;
11962 #endif
11964 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
11965 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
11966 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
11967 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
11968 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11969 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11970 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
11971 return 0;
11973 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
11974 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11975 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11976 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11977 row = it.glyph_row;
11979 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
11980 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11981 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11982 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
11983 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
11984 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
11985 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
11986 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
11987 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
11988 do. */
11989 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11991 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
11993 int nlines;
11995 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
11996 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
11998 Lisp_Object frame;
11999 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12001 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12002 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12003 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12004 make_number (nlines)),
12005 Qnil));
12006 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12008 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12009 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12010 return 1;
12015 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
12017 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
12019 int border, rows, height, extra;
12021 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
12022 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
12023 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
12024 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
12025 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
12026 border = f->border_width;
12027 else
12028 border = 0;
12029 if (border < 0)
12030 border = 0;
12032 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
12033 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
12034 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
12036 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12038 int h = 0;
12039 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12041 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12042 extra -= h;
12044 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12047 else
12049 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12050 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12053 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12054 window, so don't do it. */
12055 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12056 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12058 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12060 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12061 int change_height_p = 0;
12063 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12064 height if there is room for more. */
12065 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12066 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12067 change_height_p = 1;
12069 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12071 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12072 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12073 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12074 if (!row->displays_text_p
12075 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12076 change_height_p = 1;
12078 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12079 change the tool-bar's height. */
12080 if (row->displays_text_p
12081 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12082 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12083 change_height_p = 1;
12085 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12086 frame parameter. */
12087 if (change_height_p)
12089 Lisp_Object frame;
12090 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12091 int nrows;
12092 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
12094 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12095 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12096 ? (nlines > old_height)
12097 : (nlines != old_height));
12098 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12100 if (change_height_p)
12102 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12103 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12104 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12105 make_number (nlines)),
12106 Qnil));
12107 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12109 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12110 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12111 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12112 return 1;
12118 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12119 return 0;
12123 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12124 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12125 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12126 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12128 static int
12129 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12131 Lisp_Object prop;
12132 int success_p;
12133 int charpos;
12135 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12136 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12137 error. */
12138 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12139 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12141 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12142 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12143 F->tool_bar_items. */
12144 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12145 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12146 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12148 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12149 success_p = 1;
12151 else
12152 success_p = 0;
12154 return success_p;
12158 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12159 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12160 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12161 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12162 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12164 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12165 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12166 1 otherwise. */
12168 static int
12169 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12170 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12172 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12173 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12174 int area;
12176 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12177 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12178 if (*glyph == NULL)
12179 return -1;
12181 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12182 f->tool_bar_items. */
12183 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12184 return -1;
12186 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12187 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12188 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12189 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12190 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12191 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12192 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12193 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12194 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12195 return 0;
12197 return 1;
12201 /* EXPORT:
12202 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12203 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12204 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12205 release. */
12207 void
12208 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12209 int modifiers)
12211 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12212 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12213 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12214 struct glyph *glyph;
12215 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12217 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
12218 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12219 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
12220 return;
12222 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12223 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12224 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12225 return;
12227 if (down_p)
12229 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12230 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12231 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
12232 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12234 else
12236 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12237 struct input_event event;
12238 EVENT_INIT (event);
12240 /* Show item in released state. */
12241 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12242 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12244 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12246 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12247 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12248 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12249 event.arg = frame;
12250 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12252 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12253 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12254 event.arg = key;
12255 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12256 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12257 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12262 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12263 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12264 note_mouse_highlight. */
12266 static void
12267 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12269 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12270 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12271 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12272 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12273 int hpos, vpos;
12274 struct glyph *glyph;
12275 struct glyph_row *row;
12276 int i;
12277 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12278 int prop_idx;
12279 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12280 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12282 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12283 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12284 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12286 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12287 return;
12290 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12291 if (rc < 0)
12293 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12294 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12295 return;
12297 else if (rc == 0)
12298 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12299 goto set_help_echo;
12301 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12303 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12304 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
12305 && f == last_mouse_frame
12306 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
12307 if (mouse_down_p
12308 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12309 return;
12311 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12312 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12314 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12315 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12316 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
12318 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12319 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12320 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12321 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12322 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12324 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12325 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12326 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12327 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12328 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
12329 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12331 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12332 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12333 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12334 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
12335 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12336 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12338 /* Display it as active. */
12339 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12340 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
12343 set_help_echo:
12345 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12346 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12347 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12348 help_echo_pos = -1;
12349 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12350 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12351 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12354 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12358 /************************************************************************
12359 Horizontal scrolling
12360 ************************************************************************/
12362 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12363 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12365 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12366 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12367 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12368 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12369 changed. */
12371 static int
12372 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12374 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12375 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12376 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12377 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12379 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12381 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12382 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12384 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12385 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12388 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12390 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12391 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12392 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12394 else
12395 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12397 while (WINDOWP (window))
12399 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12401 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12402 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12403 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12404 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12405 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12407 int h_margin;
12408 int text_area_width;
12409 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12410 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12411 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12412 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12413 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12414 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12415 ? desired_cursor_row
12416 : current_cursor_row);
12417 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12419 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12421 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12422 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12424 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12425 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12426 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12427 inside the left margin and the window is already
12428 hscrolled. */
12429 && ((!row_r2l_p
12430 && ((w->hscroll
12431 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12432 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12433 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12434 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12435 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12436 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12437 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12438 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12439 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12440 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12441 || (row_r2l_p
12442 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12443 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12444 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12445 are actually truncated on the left. */
12446 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12447 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12448 || (w->hscroll
12449 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12451 struct it it;
12452 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12453 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12454 ptrdiff_t pt;
12455 int wanted_x;
12457 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12458 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12459 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12461 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12462 pt = PT;
12463 else
12465 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12466 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12467 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12470 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12471 a line with infinite width. */
12472 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12473 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12474 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12475 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12477 /* Position cursor in window. */
12478 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12479 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12480 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12481 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12482 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12483 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12484 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12485 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12486 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12488 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12489 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12490 - h_margin;
12491 else
12492 wanted_x = text_area_width
12493 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12494 - h_margin;
12495 hscroll
12496 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12498 else
12500 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12501 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12502 + h_margin;
12503 else
12504 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12505 + h_margin;
12506 hscroll
12507 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12509 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12511 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12512 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12513 redisplay. */
12514 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12516 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12517 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12518 hscrolled_p = 1;
12523 window = w->next;
12526 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12527 return hscrolled_p;
12531 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12532 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12533 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12534 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12535 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12537 static int
12538 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12540 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12541 if (hscrolled_p)
12542 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12543 return hscrolled_p;
12548 /************************************************************************
12549 Redisplay
12550 ************************************************************************/
12552 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12553 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12554 session. */
12556 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12558 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12560 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12561 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12563 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12565 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12567 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12569 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12571 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12572 try_window_id. */
12574 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12576 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12577 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12578 resulting string to stderr. */
12580 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12581 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12583 static void
12584 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12586 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12587 int len = strlen (method);
12588 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12589 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12590 va_list ap;
12592 if (len && remaining)
12594 method[len] = '|';
12595 --remaining, ++len;
12598 va_start (ap, fmt);
12599 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12600 va_end (ap);
12602 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12603 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12605 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12606 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12607 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12608 : "no buffer"),
12609 method + len);
12612 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12615 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12616 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12617 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12618 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12620 static int
12621 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12622 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12624 int unchanged_p = 1;
12626 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12627 if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
12628 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12630 /* Gap in the line? */
12631 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12632 unchanged_p = 0;
12634 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12635 if (unchanged_p
12636 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12637 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12638 unchanged_p = 0;
12640 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12641 beginning of the line. */
12642 if (unchanged_p
12643 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12644 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12645 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12646 unchanged_p = 0;
12648 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12649 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12650 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12651 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12652 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12653 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12654 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12655 if (unchanged_p)
12657 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12658 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12659 unchanged_p = 0;
12660 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12661 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12662 unchanged_p = 0;
12665 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12666 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12667 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12668 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12669 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12670 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12671 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12672 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12673 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12674 unchanged_p = 0;
12677 return unchanged_p;
12681 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12682 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12684 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12685 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12686 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12688 void
12689 redisplay (void)
12691 redisplay_internal ();
12695 static Lisp_Object
12696 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12698 Lisp_Object val;
12700 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12701 return val;
12703 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12706 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12707 static int
12708 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12710 Lisp_Object vlist;
12712 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12713 CONSP (vlist);
12714 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12716 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12717 Lisp_Object val;
12719 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12720 continue;
12721 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12722 if (MARKERP (val)
12723 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12724 return 1;
12726 return 0;
12730 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12731 has changed. */
12733 static int
12734 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12736 Lisp_Object vlist;
12738 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12739 CONSP (vlist);
12740 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12742 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12743 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12745 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12746 continue;
12747 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12748 if (!MARKERP (val))
12749 continue;
12750 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12751 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12752 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12753 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12754 return 1;
12756 return 0;
12759 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12761 static void
12762 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12764 Lisp_Object vlist;
12766 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12767 CONSP (vlist);
12768 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12770 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12772 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12773 continue;
12775 if (up_to_date > 0)
12777 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12778 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12779 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12780 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12781 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12783 else if (up_to_date < 0
12784 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12786 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12787 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12793 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12794 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12795 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12797 static Lisp_Object
12798 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12800 Lisp_Object vlist;
12802 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12803 CONSP (vlist);
12804 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12806 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12807 Lisp_Object val;
12809 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12810 continue;
12812 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12814 if (MARKERP (val)
12815 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12816 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12818 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12819 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12820 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12821 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12823 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12824 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12826 int fringe_bitmap;
12827 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12828 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12830 #endif
12831 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap. */
12833 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12837 return Qnil;
12840 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12841 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12842 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12844 static int
12845 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
12846 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
12848 ptrdiff_t start, end;
12849 Lisp_Object prop;
12850 Lisp_Object buffer;
12852 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12853 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12854 same buffer. */
12855 if (prev_buf == buf)
12857 if (prev_pt == pt)
12858 /* Point didn't move. */
12859 return 0;
12861 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12862 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12863 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12864 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12865 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12866 point moved out of the composition. */
12867 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12870 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12871 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12872 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12873 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12874 && start < pt && end > pt);
12878 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12879 in window W. */
12881 static void
12882 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12884 if (b->clip_changed
12885 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12886 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12887 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12888 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12889 b->clip_changed = 0;
12891 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12892 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12893 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12894 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12895 check. */
12896 if (!b->clip_changed
12897 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12899 ptrdiff_t pt;
12901 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12902 pt = PT;
12903 else
12904 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12906 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12907 || pt != w->last_point)
12908 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12909 w->last_point,
12910 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12911 b->clip_changed = 1;
12916 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12917 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12918 directly. */
12920 static void
12921 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12923 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12924 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12925 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12927 eassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12929 selected_frame = frame;
12931 do {
12932 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist;
12933 CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12934 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12935 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12936 SYMBOLP (tem))
12937 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12938 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12939 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12940 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12941 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12942 find_symbol_value (tem);
12943 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12947 #define STOP_POLLING \
12948 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12949 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12951 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12952 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12953 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
12956 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
12957 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
12959 static void
12960 redisplay_internal (void)
12962 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
12963 struct window *sw;
12964 struct frame *fr;
12965 int pending;
12966 int must_finish = 0;
12967 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
12968 int number_of_visible_frames;
12969 ptrdiff_t count, count1;
12970 struct frame *sf;
12971 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
12972 Lisp_Object old_frame = selected_frame;
12973 struct backtrace backtrace;
12975 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
12976 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
12977 int consider_all_windows_p;
12979 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow. */
12980 int update_miniwindow_p = 0;
12982 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
12984 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
12985 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
12986 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
12987 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
12988 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
12989 return;
12991 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
12992 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
12993 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
12994 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
12995 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
12997 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
12998 return;
13000 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
13001 if (popup_activated ())
13002 return;
13003 #endif
13005 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
13006 if (redisplaying_p)
13007 return;
13009 /* Record a function that clears redisplaying_p
13010 when we leave this function. */
13011 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13012 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay, selected_frame);
13013 redisplaying_p = 1;
13014 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
13016 /* Record this function, so it appears on the profiler's backtraces. */
13017 backtrace.next = backtrace_list;
13018 backtrace.function = Qredisplay_internal;
13019 backtrace.args = &Qnil;
13020 backtrace.nargs = 0;
13021 backtrace.debug_on_exit = 0;
13022 backtrace_list = &backtrace;
13025 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13027 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13029 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13030 f->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
13034 retry:
13035 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
13036 sw = w;
13038 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13039 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13040 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
13041 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
13042 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
13043 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
13044 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13046 pending = 0;
13047 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13048 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13049 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13050 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13051 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13053 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
13054 necessary, do it. */
13055 if (fonts_changed_p)
13057 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
13058 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13059 fonts_changed_p = 0;
13062 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13063 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13064 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13065 if (face_change_count)
13066 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13068 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13069 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13071 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13072 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13073 the whole thing. */
13074 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13075 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13076 #ifndef DOS_NT
13077 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13078 #endif
13079 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13082 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking
13083 for resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames
13084 are visible. See the comment in frame.h for
13085 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13087 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13089 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13091 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13093 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13095 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13096 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13097 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13098 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13102 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13103 do_pending_window_change (1);
13105 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13106 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13107 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13109 sw = w;
13110 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13113 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13114 if (frame_garbaged)
13115 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13117 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13118 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13119 prepare_menu_bars ();
13121 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
13122 update_mode_lines++;
13124 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13125 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13127 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13128 if (buffer_shared > 1)
13129 update_mode_lines++;
13132 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
13133 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13134 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
13136 /* If %c is in the mode line, update it if needed. */
13137 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
13138 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
13139 where no change is needed. */
13140 && !(PT == w->last_point
13141 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
13142 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13143 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
13144 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13146 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
13148 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
13150 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
13151 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. See
13152 there. */
13153 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines || buffer_shared > 1
13154 || cursor_type_changed);
13156 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13157 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13158 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13159 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
13161 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13162 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13163 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13164 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13165 the echo area should be cleared. */
13166 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13167 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13168 || (message_cleared_p
13169 && minibuf_level == 0
13170 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13171 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13172 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13174 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13176 if (message_cleared_p)
13177 update_miniwindow_p = 1;
13179 must_finish = 1;
13181 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13182 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13183 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13184 the echo area. */
13185 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13186 message_cleared_p = 0;
13188 if (fonts_changed_p)
13189 goto retry;
13190 else if (window_height_changed_p)
13192 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13193 ++update_mode_lines;
13194 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13196 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13197 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13198 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13199 if (frame_garbaged)
13200 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13203 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13204 && (current_buffer->clip_changed
13205 || w->last_modified < MODIFF
13206 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13207 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13209 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13210 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13211 must_finish = 1;
13212 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
13213 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function needs
13214 to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
13215 consider_all_frames. */
13216 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13217 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13218 ++update_mode_lines;
13220 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13221 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13222 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13223 if (frame_garbaged)
13224 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13228 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
13229 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
13230 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
13231 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13232 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
13233 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
13234 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
13235 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
13236 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
13237 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13239 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13240 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13241 set in display_line and record information about the line
13242 containing the cursor. */
13243 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13244 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13245 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13246 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13247 && !w->update_mode_line
13248 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13249 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13250 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13251 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13252 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13253 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13254 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
13255 && !w->force_start
13256 && !w->optional_new_start
13257 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13258 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13259 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13260 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13261 must be unchanged. */
13262 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13263 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13265 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13266 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13267 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13268 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13269 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13270 goto cancel;
13271 else if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
13272 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF
13273 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13275 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13276 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13277 line 1340).
13279 For instance, in the following case:
13281 -------- Insert --------
13282 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13283 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13284 ^^ ^^
13285 -------- --------
13287 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13288 optimization. */
13290 struct it it;
13291 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13293 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13294 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13295 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13297 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13298 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13299 goto cancel;
13301 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13302 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13303 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13304 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13305 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13306 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13307 display_line (&it);
13309 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13310 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13311 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13312 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13313 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13314 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13315 /* Line ends as before. */
13316 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13317 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13318 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13319 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13321 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13322 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13323 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13325 struct glyph_row *row
13326 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13327 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13329 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13330 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13331 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13332 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13333 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13334 delta = (Z
13335 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13336 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13337 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13338 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13339 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13341 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13342 this_line_vpos + 1,
13343 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13344 delta, delta_bytes);
13347 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13348 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13349 adjusted. */
13350 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
13352 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
13353 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos));
13355 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
13356 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13357 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos - 1));
13358 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
13360 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13361 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13363 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13364 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13365 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13366 #endif
13367 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13368 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13369 #endif
13370 goto update;
13372 else
13373 goto cancel;
13375 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13376 PT == w->last_point
13377 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13378 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13379 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13380 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13382 if (!must_finish)
13384 do_pending_window_change (1);
13385 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13386 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13387 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13388 goto retry;
13390 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13391 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13392 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13393 goto end_of_redisplay;
13395 goto update;
13397 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13398 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13399 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13400 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13401 && (EQ (selected_window,
13402 BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13403 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13404 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13405 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13406 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13408 struct it it;
13409 struct glyph_row *row;
13411 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13412 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13413 next visible position. */
13414 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13415 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13416 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13417 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13418 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13420 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13421 moves over before-strings. */
13422 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13424 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13425 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13426 row->enabled_p))
13428 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13429 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13430 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13431 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13432 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13433 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13434 #endif
13435 goto update;
13437 else
13438 goto cancel;
13441 cancel:
13442 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13443 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13446 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13447 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared > 1;
13448 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13449 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13450 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13451 #endif
13453 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13454 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13455 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13457 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13459 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13461 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13462 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13464 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13465 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13466 buffer_shared = 0;
13468 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13470 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13472 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13473 frames. */
13474 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13475 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13476 continue;
13478 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13480 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13481 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13482 variables. */
13483 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13485 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13486 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13487 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13488 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13490 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13491 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13493 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13494 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13495 continue;
13497 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13498 nuked should now go away. */
13499 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13500 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13502 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13503 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13504 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13505 if (fonts_changed_p)
13506 goto retry;
13508 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13510 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13511 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13513 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13514 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13515 goto retry;
13518 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13519 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13520 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13521 error. */
13522 if (interrupt_input)
13523 unrequest_sigio ();
13524 STOP_POLLING;
13526 /* Update the display. */
13527 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13528 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13529 f->updated_p = 1;
13534 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13535 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13536 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13537 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13538 sure this stays contained. */
13539 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13540 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window,
13541 selected_window));
13543 if (!pending)
13545 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13546 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13547 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13548 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13550 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13551 if (f->updated_p)
13553 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13554 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13555 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13560 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13562 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13563 struct frame *mini_frame;
13565 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13566 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13567 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13568 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13569 list_of_error,
13570 redisplay_window_error);
13571 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13572 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13573 list_of_error,
13574 redisplay_window_error);
13576 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13578 update:
13579 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13580 if (fonts_changed_p)
13581 goto retry;
13583 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13584 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13585 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13586 if (interrupt_input)
13587 unrequest_sigio ();
13588 STOP_POLLING;
13590 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13592 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13593 goto retry;
13595 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13596 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13599 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13600 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13601 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13602 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13603 it here. */
13604 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13605 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13607 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13609 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13610 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13611 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13612 goto retry;
13616 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13617 thorough update the next time. */
13618 if (pending)
13620 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13621 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13622 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13623 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13625 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13626 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13628 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13629 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13630 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13631 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13632 update_mode_lines = 1;
13634 else
13636 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13638 /* This has already been done above if
13639 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13640 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13642 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13643 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13645 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13646 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13649 update_mode_lines = 0;
13650 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13651 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13654 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13655 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13656 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13657 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13658 if (interrupt_input)
13659 request_sigio ();
13660 RESUME_POLLING;
13662 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13663 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13664 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13665 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13666 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13667 frames here explicitly. */
13668 if (!pending)
13670 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13671 int new_count = 0;
13673 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13675 int this_is_visible = 0;
13677 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13678 this_is_visible = 1;
13679 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13680 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13681 this_is_visible = 1;
13683 if (this_is_visible)
13684 new_count++;
13687 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13688 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13691 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13692 do_pending_window_change (1);
13694 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13695 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13696 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13697 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13698 goto retry;
13700 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13702 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13703 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13704 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13706 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13708 clear_face_cache (0);
13709 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13712 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13713 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13715 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13716 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13718 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13720 end_of_redisplay:
13721 backtrace_list = backtrace.next;
13722 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13723 RESUME_POLLING;
13727 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13728 another message has been requested in its place.
13730 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13731 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13732 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13733 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13735 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13736 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13738 void
13739 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13741 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13743 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13745 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13746 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13747 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13748 redisplay_internal ();
13749 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13751 else
13752 redisplay_internal ();
13754 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13755 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13756 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13760 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in redisplay_internal.
13761 Clear redisplaying_p. Also, select the previously
13762 selected frame, unless it has been deleted (by an X connection
13763 failure during redisplay, for example). */
13765 static Lisp_Object
13766 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object old_frame)
13768 redisplaying_p = 0;
13769 if (! EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13770 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13771 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13772 return Qnil;
13776 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13777 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13778 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13779 redisplay_internal is called. */
13781 static void
13782 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13784 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13786 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13788 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13789 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13790 w->last_had_star
13791 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13793 if (accurate_p)
13795 b->clip_changed = 0;
13796 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13798 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13799 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13800 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13801 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13803 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13804 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13805 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13807 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13808 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13810 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13811 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13812 else
13813 w->last_point = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
13817 if (accurate_p)
13819 wset_window_end_valid (w, w->buffer);
13820 w->update_mode_line = 0;
13825 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13826 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13827 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13828 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13830 void
13831 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13833 struct window *w;
13835 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13837 w = XWINDOW (window);
13838 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13840 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13841 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13842 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13843 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13846 if (accurate_p)
13848 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13850 else
13852 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13853 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13854 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13855 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13860 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13861 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13862 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13863 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13865 Lisp_Object
13866 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13868 Lisp_Object val;
13870 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13872 val = dp->ascii;
13873 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13874 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13876 else
13878 Lisp_Object table;
13880 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13881 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13883 if (NILP (val))
13884 val = dp->defalt;
13885 return val;
13890 /***********************************************************************
13891 Window Redisplay
13892 ***********************************************************************/
13894 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13896 static void
13897 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13899 while (!NILP (window))
13901 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13903 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13904 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13905 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13906 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13907 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13909 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13910 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13911 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13912 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13913 list_of_error,
13914 redisplay_window_error);
13917 window = w->next;
13921 static Lisp_Object
13922 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13924 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13925 return Qnil;
13928 static Lisp_Object
13929 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13931 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13932 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13933 return Qnil;
13936 static Lisp_Object
13937 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13939 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13940 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13941 return Qnil;
13945 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13946 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13947 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13948 positions.
13950 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13952 static int
13953 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13954 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13955 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
13956 int dy, int dvpos)
13958 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13959 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13960 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13961 /* The last known character position in row. */
13962 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13963 int x = row->x;
13964 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
13965 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13966 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13967 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13968 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13969 touch. */
13970 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13971 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13972 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13973 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13974 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13975 display string. */
13976 int string_seen = 0;
13977 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13978 glyph row. */
13979 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
13980 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
13981 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13982 `cursor' property. */
13983 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
13984 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13985 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13986 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13988 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
13989 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
13990 deal with such calamities. */
13991 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
13992 if (row->mode_line_p)
13993 return 0;
13995 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
13996 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
13997 terminal frames. */
13998 if (row->displays_text_p)
14000 if (!row->reversed_p)
14002 while (glyph < end
14003 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14004 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14006 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14007 ++glyph;
14009 while (end > glyph
14010 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
14011 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
14012 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
14013 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
14014 --end;
14015 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
14016 glyph_after = end;
14018 else
14020 struct glyph *g;
14022 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
14023 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
14024 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
14025 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
14027 while (glyph > end + 1
14028 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14029 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14031 --glyph;
14032 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14034 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
14035 --glyph;
14036 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
14037 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
14038 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
14039 x += g->pixel_width;
14040 while (end < glyph
14041 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14042 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14043 ++end;
14044 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14045 glyph_after = end;
14048 else if (row->reversed_p)
14050 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14051 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14052 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14053 cursor = end - 1;
14054 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14055 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14056 adjacent windows. */
14057 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14058 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14059 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14060 cursor--;
14061 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14064 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14065 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14066 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14067 point, the other after it. */
14068 if (!row->reversed_p)
14069 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14070 glyph < end
14071 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14072 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14074 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14076 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14078 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14079 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14080 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14081 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14082 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14084 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14085 display the cursor. */
14086 if (dpos == 0)
14088 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14089 break;
14091 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14092 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14093 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14095 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14096 glyph_before = glyph;
14098 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14100 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14101 glyph_after = glyph;
14104 else if (dpos == 0)
14105 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14107 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14109 Lisp_Object chprop;
14110 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14112 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14113 glyph->object);
14114 if (!NILP (chprop))
14116 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14117 look up the buffer position of that property and
14118 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14119 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14120 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14121 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14122 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14123 text is completely covered by display properties,
14124 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14125 ever seen in the row. */
14126 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14127 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14128 pos_after, 0);
14130 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14131 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14133 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14135 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14136 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14137 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14138 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14139 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14140 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14141 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14142 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14143 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14144 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14145 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14146 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14147 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14149 cursor = glyph;
14150 break;
14154 string_seen = 1;
14156 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14157 ++glyph;
14159 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14160 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14162 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14164 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14166 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14167 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14168 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14169 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14170 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14172 if (dpos == 0)
14174 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14175 break;
14177 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14179 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14180 glyph_before = glyph;
14182 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14184 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14185 glyph_after = glyph;
14188 else if (dpos == 0)
14189 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14191 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14193 Lisp_Object chprop;
14194 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14196 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14197 glyph->object);
14198 if (!NILP (chprop))
14200 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14201 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14202 pos_after, 0);
14204 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14205 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14207 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14209 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14210 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14211 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14212 this glyph. */
14213 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14215 cursor = glyph;
14216 break;
14219 string_seen = 1;
14221 --glyph;
14222 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14224 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14225 break;
14227 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14230 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14231 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14232 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14233 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14234 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14235 && !(bpos_max < pt_old && pt_old <= bpos_covered))
14237 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14238 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14239 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14240 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14241 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14242 int empty_line_p =
14243 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14244 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0
14245 /* On a TTY, continued and truncated rows also have a glyph at
14246 their end whose OBJECT is zero and whose CHARPOS is
14247 positive (the continuation and truncation glyphs), but such
14248 rows are obviously not "empty". */
14249 && !(row->continued_p || row->truncated_on_right_p);
14251 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14253 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14255 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14256 if (!row->reversed_p)
14258 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14259 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14260 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14261 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14262 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14263 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14264 that one. */
14265 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14266 glyph++;
14268 else /* row is reversed */
14270 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14271 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14272 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14273 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14274 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14275 glyph--;
14278 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14280 cursor = glyph_after;
14281 x = -1;
14283 else if (string_seen)
14285 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14287 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14288 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14289 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14290 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14291 buffer. */
14292 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14293 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14295 x = -1;
14297 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14298 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14299 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14300 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14301 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14302 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14304 glyph_after = end;
14305 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14308 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14309 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14310 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14311 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14312 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14313 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14314 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14315 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14316 if (!row->reversed_p)
14318 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14319 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14321 else
14323 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14324 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14326 for (glyph = start + incr;
14327 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14330 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14331 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14332 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14333 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14335 Lisp_Object str;
14336 ptrdiff_t tem;
14337 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14338 need to search for it one position farther. */
14339 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14340 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14342 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14343 str = glyph->object;
14344 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14345 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14346 || pos <= tem)
14348 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14349 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14350 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14351 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14352 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14353 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14354 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14355 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14356 unidirectional version, we will display the
14357 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14358 if (tem == 0
14359 || tem == pt_old
14360 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14362 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14363 been reordered. Find the one with the
14364 smallest string position. Or there could
14365 be a character in the string with the
14366 `cursor' property, which means display
14367 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14368 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14370 if (tem)
14372 cursor = glyph;
14373 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14375 for ( ;
14376 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14377 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14378 glyph += incr)
14380 Lisp_Object cprop;
14381 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14383 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14384 Qcursor,
14385 glyph->object);
14386 if (!NILP (cprop))
14388 cursor = glyph;
14389 break;
14391 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14393 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14394 cursor = glyph;
14398 if (tem == pt_old
14399 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14400 goto compute_x;
14402 if (tem)
14403 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14405 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14406 glyphs that came from it. */
14407 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14408 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14409 glyph += incr;
14411 else
14412 glyph += incr;
14415 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14416 the cursor is not on this line. */
14417 if (cursor == NULL
14418 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14419 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14420 && STRINGP (end->object)
14421 && row->continued_p)
14422 return 0;
14424 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14425 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14426 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14427 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14428 code below to figure this out. */
14429 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14431 cursor = glyph_before;
14432 x = -1;
14434 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14435 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14436 || (!empty_line_p
14437 && (row->reversed_p
14438 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14439 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14441 cursor = glyph_after;
14442 x = -1;
14446 compute_x:
14447 if (cursor != NULL)
14448 glyph = cursor;
14449 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14450 && pos_before == pos_after
14451 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14452 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14453 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14455 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14456 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14457 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14458 use case. */
14459 glyph =
14460 row->reversed_p
14461 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14462 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14464 if (x < 0)
14466 struct glyph *g;
14468 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14469 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14471 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14472 emacs_abort ();
14473 x += g->pixel_width;
14477 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14478 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14479 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14480 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14481 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14482 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14483 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14484 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14485 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14486 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14487 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14488 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14489 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14490 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14491 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14492 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14493 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14495 struct glyph *g1 =
14496 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14498 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14499 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14500 return 0;
14501 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14502 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14503 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14504 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14505 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14506 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14507 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14508 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14509 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14510 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14511 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14512 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14513 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14514 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14515 Qcursor, g1->object))
14516 /* previous candidate is from the same display
14517 string as this one, and the display string
14518 came from a text property */
14519 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14520 && string_from_text_prop)
14521 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14522 position is not an exact match */
14523 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14524 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14525 return 0;
14526 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14527 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14528 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14529 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14530 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14531 || (!row->continued_p
14532 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14533 && glyph->charpos == 0
14534 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14535 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14536 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14537 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14538 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14539 positions. */
14540 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14541 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14542 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14543 return 0;
14545 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14546 w->cursor.x = x;
14547 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14548 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14550 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14552 if (!row->continued_p
14553 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14554 && row->x == 0)
14556 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14558 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14559 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14560 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14561 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14563 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14564 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14565 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14566 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14568 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14569 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14570 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14571 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14573 else
14574 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14577 return 1;
14581 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14582 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14584 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14586 static struct text_pos
14587 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14589 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14590 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14592 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14593 emacs_abort ();
14595 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14597 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14598 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14599 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14600 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14601 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14604 return startp;
14608 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14609 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14610 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14611 or we cannot tell.)
14613 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14614 is higher than window.
14616 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14617 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14619 static int
14620 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14622 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14623 struct glyph_row *row;
14624 int window_height;
14626 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14627 return 1;
14629 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14630 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14631 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14632 return 1;
14634 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14635 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14637 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14638 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14639 return 1;
14641 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14642 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14643 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14644 if (row->height >= window_height)
14646 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14647 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14648 return 1;
14650 return 0;
14654 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14655 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14656 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14657 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14658 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14660 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14661 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14663 Value is
14665 1 if scrolling succeeded
14667 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14669 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14670 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14672 enum
14674 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14675 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14676 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14679 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14681 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14682 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14683 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14685 static int
14686 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14687 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14688 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14690 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14691 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14692 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14693 struct it it;
14694 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14695 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14696 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14697 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14698 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14699 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14701 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14702 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14703 #endif
14705 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14707 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14708 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14709 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14710 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14711 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14712 else
14713 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14715 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14716 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14717 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14718 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14719 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14721 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14722 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14724 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14725 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14726 point into view. */
14727 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14728 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14729 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14730 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14731 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14732 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14733 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14734 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14735 else
14736 scroll_max = 0;
14738 too_near_end:
14740 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14741 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14743 int scroll_margin_y;
14745 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14746 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14747 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14748 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14749 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14750 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14751 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14753 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14755 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14756 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14757 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14758 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14759 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14760 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14761 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14762 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14764 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14765 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14766 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14767 fully visible. */
14768 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14769 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14770 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14772 if (dy > scroll_max)
14773 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14775 if (dy > 0)
14776 scroll_down_p = 1;
14780 if (scroll_down_p)
14782 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14783 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14784 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14785 move it down by scroll_step. */
14786 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14787 amount_to_scroll
14788 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14789 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14790 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14791 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14792 else
14794 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14795 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14796 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14798 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14799 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14800 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14801 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14802 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14803 the window. This could happen if the value of
14804 scroll_up_aggressively is too large and there are
14805 non-zero margins, because scroll_up_aggressively
14806 means put point that fraction of window height
14807 _from_the_bottom_margin_. */
14808 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14809 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14810 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14814 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14815 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14817 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14818 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14819 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14820 else
14822 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14823 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14824 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14825 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14826 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14827 below window bottom have different height. */
14828 struct it it1;
14829 void *it1data = NULL;
14830 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14831 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14832 int start_y;
14834 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14835 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14836 do {
14837 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14838 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14839 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14840 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14843 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14844 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14845 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14846 startp = it.current.pos;
14848 else
14850 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14852 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14853 window. */
14854 if (this_scroll_margin)
14856 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14857 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14858 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14861 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14863 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14864 above what is displayed in the window. */
14865 int y0, y_to_move;
14867 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14868 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14869 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14870 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max or if we
14871 didn't reach the scroll margin position. */
14872 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14873 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14874 y0 = it.current_y;
14875 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14876 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14877 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14878 y_to_move, -1,
14879 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14880 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14881 if (dy > scroll_max
14882 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14883 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14885 /* Compute new window start. */
14886 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14888 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14889 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14890 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14891 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14892 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14893 else
14895 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14896 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14897 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14899 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14900 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14901 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14902 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14903 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14904 bottom of the window, if the value of
14905 scroll_down_aggressively happens to be too
14906 large. */
14907 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14908 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14909 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14913 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14914 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14916 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14917 startp = it.current.pos;
14921 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14922 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14924 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14925 doesn't appear. */
14926 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14927 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14928 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14930 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14931 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14933 else
14935 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14936 if (!just_this_one_p
14937 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14938 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14939 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
14941 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14942 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14943 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14944 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14945 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14946 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14947 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14949 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14950 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14951 goto too_near_end;
14953 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14956 return rc;
14960 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14961 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14962 was computed.
14964 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14965 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14966 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14968 static int
14969 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14971 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14972 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14974 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14976 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14977 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14978 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14979 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14980 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14982 struct it it;
14983 struct glyph_row *row;
14985 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14986 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14987 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14988 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14989 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14991 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14992 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14993 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14994 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14995 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14996 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14998 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14999 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
15000 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
15001 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
15003 int min_distance, distance;
15005 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
15006 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
15007 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
15008 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
15009 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
15010 minimum distance from the old window start. */
15011 pos = it.current.pos;
15012 min_distance = INFINITY;
15013 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
15014 distance < min_distance)
15016 min_distance = distance;
15017 pos = it.current.pos;
15018 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
15021 /* Set the window start there. */
15022 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
15023 window_start_changed_p = 1;
15027 return window_start_changed_p;
15031 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
15032 with window start STARTP. Value is
15034 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
15036 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
15038 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
15039 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
15040 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
15042 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
15043 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
15044 first. */
15046 enum
15048 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
15049 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
15050 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
15051 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
15054 static int
15055 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15057 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15058 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15059 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15061 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15062 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15063 return rc;
15064 #endif
15066 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15067 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15068 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15069 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15071 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15072 not moved off the frame. */
15073 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15074 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15075 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15076 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15077 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15078 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15079 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15080 cases. */
15081 && !update_mode_lines
15082 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15083 && !cursor_type_changed
15084 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
15085 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
15086 set the cursor. */
15087 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15088 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15089 && NILP (w->region_showing)
15090 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15091 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15092 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15093 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15094 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15095 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15096 handles the same cases. */
15097 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15098 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
15099 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
15100 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
15101 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
15102 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
15103 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
15104 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
15105 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15106 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15108 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15109 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15111 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15112 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15113 #endif
15115 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15116 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15117 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15119 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15120 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15122 else
15123 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15125 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15126 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15127 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15129 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15130 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15131 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
15132 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15133 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15134 else
15136 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
15137 if (row->mode_line_p)
15138 ++row;
15139 if (!row->enabled_p)
15140 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15143 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15145 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15146 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15148 if (PT > w->last_point)
15150 /* Point has moved forward. */
15151 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15152 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15154 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15155 ++row;
15158 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15159 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15160 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15161 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15162 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15163 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
15164 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
15165 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15166 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15167 ++row;
15169 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15170 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15171 the next line would be drawn, and that
15172 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15173 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15174 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15175 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15176 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15177 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15178 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15179 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15180 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15181 scroll_p = 1;
15183 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15185 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15186 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15187 while (!row->mode_line_p
15188 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15189 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15190 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15191 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15192 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15193 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15194 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15195 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15197 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15198 --row;
15201 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15202 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15203 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15204 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15205 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15206 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15207 || row->mode_line_p)
15209 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15210 if (row->mode_line_p)
15211 ++row;
15214 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15215 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15216 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15217 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15218 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15219 ++row;
15221 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15222 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15223 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15224 scroll_p = 1;
15226 else
15228 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15229 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15230 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15233 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15234 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15236 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15237 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15238 must_scroll = 1;
15240 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15241 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15243 struct glyph_row *row1;
15245 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15246 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15247 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15248 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15249 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15250 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15251 in such rows. */
15252 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15253 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15254 bidi-reordered rows. */
15255 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15256 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15257 --row)
15259 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15260 without finding the first row of a continued
15261 line, give up. */
15262 if (row <= row1)
15264 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15265 break;
15267 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15270 if (must_scroll)
15272 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15273 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15274 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15275 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15276 && !row->mode_line_p
15277 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15279 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15280 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15281 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15282 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15283 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15285 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15286 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15287 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15288 about it. */
15289 *scroll_step = 1;
15290 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15292 else
15294 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15295 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15296 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15297 else
15298 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15301 else if (scroll_p)
15302 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15303 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15304 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15306 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15307 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15308 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15309 find the best candidate. */
15310 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15311 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15312 bidi-reordered rows. */
15313 int rv = 0;
15317 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15319 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15320 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15321 && cursor_row_p (row))
15322 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15323 0, 0, 0, 0);
15324 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15325 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15326 is set, we are done. */
15327 at_zv_p =
15328 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15329 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15330 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15331 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15332 w->cursor.vpos))
15334 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15335 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15336 struct glyph *g =
15337 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15338 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15340 exact_match_p =
15341 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15342 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15343 && (g->charpos == PT
15344 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15346 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15348 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15349 break;
15351 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15352 break;
15353 ++row;
15355 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15356 || row->continued_p)
15357 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15358 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15359 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15360 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15361 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15362 to the caller that this method failed. */
15363 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15364 && !(rv
15365 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15366 && !row->continued_p))
15367 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15368 else if (rv)
15369 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15371 else
15375 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15377 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15378 break;
15380 ++row;
15382 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15383 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15384 && cursor_row_p (row));
15389 return rc;
15392 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15393 static
15394 #endif
15395 void
15396 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15398 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15400 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15401 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15402 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15403 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15404 visible region.
15406 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15407 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15408 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15409 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15411 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15412 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15413 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15414 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15415 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15416 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15418 if (end < start)
15419 end = start;
15420 if (whole < (end - start))
15421 whole = end - start;
15423 else
15424 start = end = whole = 0;
15426 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15427 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15428 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15429 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15433 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15434 selected_window is redisplayed.
15436 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
15437 fonts_changed_p. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15438 retry. */
15440 static void
15441 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15443 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15444 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15445 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15446 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15447 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15448 int update_mode_line;
15449 int tem;
15450 struct it it;
15451 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15452 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15453 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15454 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15455 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15456 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15457 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15458 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15459 int rc;
15460 int centering_position = -1;
15461 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15462 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15464 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15465 opoint = lpoint;
15467 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15468 eassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15469 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15470 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15471 #endif
15473 restart:
15474 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15476 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15477 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15478 || update_mode_lines
15479 || buffer->clip_changed
15480 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15482 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15484 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15485 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15487 if (update_mode_line)
15488 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15489 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15490 goto finish_menu_bars;
15491 else
15492 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15493 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15495 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15496 || minibuf_level == 0)
15497 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15498 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15499 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15500 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15501 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15503 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15504 it. */
15505 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15506 struct glyph_row *row;
15507 int y;
15509 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15510 y < yb;
15511 y += row->height, ++row)
15512 blank_row (w, row, y);
15513 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15516 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15519 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15520 value. */
15521 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15522 variables. */
15523 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15525 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15526 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15527 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15528 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15529 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15530 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15532 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15533 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15534 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15535 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15536 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15538 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15539 goto restart;
15542 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15543 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15545 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15547 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15549 buffer_unchanged_p
15550 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15551 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15552 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15553 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15555 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15556 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15557 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15559 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15560 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15561 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15562 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15564 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15567 /* Some sanity checks. */
15568 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15569 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15570 emacs_abort ();
15571 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15572 emacs_abort ();
15574 /* If %c is in mode line, update it if needed. */
15575 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15576 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
15577 where no change is needed. */
15578 && !(PT == w->last_point
15579 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15580 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
15581 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
15582 update_mode_line = 1;
15584 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15585 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15586 if (!just_this_one_p)
15588 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15589 current_base = current_buffer;
15590 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15591 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15592 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15593 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15594 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15595 if (current_base == window_base)
15596 buffer_shared++;
15599 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15600 window, set up appropriate value. */
15601 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15603 ptrdiff_t new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15604 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15605 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15607 new_pt = BEGV;
15608 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15609 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15611 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15613 new_pt = ZV;
15614 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15615 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15618 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15619 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15622 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15623 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15624 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15625 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15626 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15627 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15629 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15631 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15632 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15634 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15635 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15636 BEG, Z);
15637 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15641 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15642 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15643 goto recenter;
15645 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15647 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15648 check whether it can be used. */
15649 if (w->optional_new_start
15650 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15651 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15653 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15654 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15655 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15656 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15657 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15658 w->force_start = 1;
15659 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15660 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15661 w->force_start = 1;
15664 force_start:
15666 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15667 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15668 if (w->force_start || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15670 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15671 int new_vpos = -1;
15673 w->force_start = 0;
15674 w->vscroll = 0;
15675 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15677 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15678 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15679 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15681 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15682 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15683 because we have scrolled. */
15684 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15685 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15686 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15687 and having them get more errors. */
15688 if (!update_mode_line
15689 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15691 update_mode_line = 1;
15692 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15693 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15696 w->last_modified = 0;
15697 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15698 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15699 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15700 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15701 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15703 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15704 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15705 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15706 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15707 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15708 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15710 w->force_start = 1;
15711 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15712 goto need_larger_matrices;
15715 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15717 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15718 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15719 can use it here. */
15720 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15723 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15725 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15726 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15727 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15730 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15731 now actually do it. */
15732 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15734 struct glyph_row *row;
15736 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15737 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15738 ++row;
15740 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15741 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15743 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15744 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15745 else if (current_buffer == old)
15746 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15748 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15750 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15751 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15752 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15753 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15755 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15756 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15757 goto need_larger_matrices;
15761 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15762 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15763 #endif
15764 goto done;
15767 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15768 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15769 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15770 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15771 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15772 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15774 switch (rc)
15776 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15777 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15778 goto done;
15780 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15781 goto try_to_scroll;
15783 default:
15784 emacs_abort ();
15787 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15788 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15789 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15790 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15791 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15793 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15794 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15795 #endif
15796 goto recenter;
15799 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15800 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15801 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15802 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15804 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15805 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15806 #endif
15808 if (fonts_changed_p)
15809 goto need_larger_matrices;
15810 if (tem > 0)
15811 goto done;
15813 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15814 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15816 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15817 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15818 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15819 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15820 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15821 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15822 || (w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15823 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)))
15825 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15827 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15828 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15829 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15831 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15832 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15833 new window start, since that would change the position under
15834 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15835 than a simple mouse-click. */
15836 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15837 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15838 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15839 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15840 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15841 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15842 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15843 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15844 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15845 bug#197). */
15846 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15847 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15848 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15849 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15850 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15851 doing so will move point from its correct position
15852 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15853 See bug#9324. */
15854 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15856 w->force_start = 1;
15857 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15858 goto force_start;
15861 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15862 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15863 #endif
15865 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15866 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15867 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15868 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15869 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15870 buffer. */
15871 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15872 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15873 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15874 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15876 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15877 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15878 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15879 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15880 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15881 goto try_to_scroll;
15884 if (fonts_changed_p)
15885 goto need_larger_matrices;
15887 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15889 if (!just_this_one_p
15890 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15891 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15892 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15893 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15895 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15897 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15898 last_line_misfit = 1;
15900 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15901 else
15902 goto done;
15904 else
15905 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15908 try_to_scroll:
15910 w->last_modified = 0;
15911 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15913 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15914 if (!update_mode_line)
15916 update_mode_line = 1;
15917 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15920 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15921 if ((scroll_conservatively
15922 || emacs_scroll_step
15923 || temp_scroll_step
15924 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15925 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15926 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15927 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15929 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15930 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15931 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15932 scroll_conservatively,
15933 emacs_scroll_step,
15934 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15935 switch (ss)
15937 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15938 goto done;
15940 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15941 goto need_larger_matrices;
15943 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15944 break;
15946 default:
15947 emacs_abort ();
15951 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15952 according to user preferences. */
15954 recenter:
15956 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15957 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15958 #endif
15960 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15962 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15963 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15964 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15966 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15967 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15968 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15969 if (centering_position < 0)
15971 int margin =
15972 scroll_margin > 0
15973 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15974 : 0;
15975 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15976 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15977 int scrolling_up;
15979 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15980 its character position. */
15981 if (margin
15982 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15983 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15984 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15985 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15986 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
15987 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15988 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15990 struct it it1;
15991 void *it1data = NULL;
15993 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15994 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15995 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
15996 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15997 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15999 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
16000 aggressive =
16001 scrolling_up
16002 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
16003 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
16005 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16006 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
16008 int pt_offset = 0;
16010 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
16011 scroll-*-aggressively. */
16012 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
16014 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
16016 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
16017 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
16018 pt_offset = 1;
16019 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
16020 margin -= 1;
16022 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
16023 point so that point will be displayed where the user
16024 wants it. */
16025 if (scrolling_up)
16027 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
16028 if (pt_offset)
16029 centering_position -= pt_offset;
16030 centering_position -=
16031 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
16032 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16033 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
16034 the window. */
16035 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
16036 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16038 else
16039 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
16041 else
16042 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
16043 from point. */
16044 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
16046 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
16048 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
16050 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
16051 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
16052 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
16053 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16054 containing PT in this case. */
16055 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16057 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16058 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16059 it.current_y = 0;
16062 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16064 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16065 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16066 get errors. */
16067 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16069 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16070 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16072 /* Redisplay the window. */
16073 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16074 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16075 || cursor_type_changed
16076 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16077 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16078 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16079 || !just_this_one_p
16080 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16081 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16082 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16083 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16085 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16086 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16087 matrices. */
16088 if (fonts_changed_p)
16089 goto need_larger_matrices;
16091 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16092 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16093 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16094 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16095 line.) */
16096 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16098 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
16099 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
16101 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16102 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16103 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16105 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16107 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16108 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16109 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16111 else
16113 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16117 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16118 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16119 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16120 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16121 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16123 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16124 if (row->mode_line_p)
16125 ++row;
16126 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16129 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16131 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16132 if (w->vscroll)
16134 w->vscroll = 0;
16135 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16136 goto recenter;
16139 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16140 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16141 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16142 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16143 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16145 int margin =
16146 scroll_margin > 0
16147 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
16148 : 0;
16149 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 2;
16151 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16152 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16153 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16154 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16155 goto done;
16158 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16159 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16160 visible, if it can be done. */
16161 if (centering_position == 0)
16162 goto done;
16164 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16165 centering_position = 0;
16166 goto recenter;
16169 done:
16171 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16172 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16173 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16175 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16176 if ((update_mode_line
16177 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16178 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16179 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16180 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16181 || (!just_this_one_p
16182 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16183 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16184 /* Line number to display. */
16185 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
16186 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16187 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
16188 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
16189 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16190 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16191 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16193 display_mode_lines (w);
16195 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16196 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16197 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16198 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16200 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16201 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16202 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16205 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16206 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16207 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16208 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16210 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16211 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16212 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16215 if (fonts_changed_p)
16216 goto need_larger_matrices;
16219 if (!line_number_displayed
16220 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
16222 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
16223 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
16226 finish_menu_bars:
16228 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16229 if (update_mode_line
16230 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16232 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16234 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16236 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16237 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16238 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16239 #else
16240 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16241 #endif
16243 else
16244 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16246 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16247 display_menu_bar (w);
16249 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16250 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16252 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16253 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16254 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16255 #else
16256 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16257 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
16258 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16259 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16260 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16261 #endif
16263 #endif
16266 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16267 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16268 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16269 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16270 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16272 update_begin (f);
16273 block_input ();
16274 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16275 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16276 unblock_input ();
16277 update_end (f);
16279 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16281 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p set,
16282 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16283 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16284 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16285 need_larger_matrices:
16287 finish_scroll_bars:
16289 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16291 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16292 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16294 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16295 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16296 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16297 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16300 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16301 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16302 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16303 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16304 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16305 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16306 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16307 else
16308 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16310 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16311 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16312 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16313 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16314 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16316 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16320 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16321 buffer position POS.
16323 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16324 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16325 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16326 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16327 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16328 set in FLAGS.) */
16331 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16333 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16334 struct it it;
16335 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16336 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16338 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16339 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16341 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16342 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16343 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16345 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16346 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16348 /* Display all lines of W. */
16349 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16351 if (display_line (&it))
16352 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16353 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16354 return 0;
16357 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16358 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16359 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16361 int this_scroll_margin;
16363 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16365 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
16366 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16368 else
16369 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16371 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16372 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16373 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16374 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16375 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16376 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16377 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16378 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16379 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16381 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16382 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16383 return -1;
16387 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16388 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
16389 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16390 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16392 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16393 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16394 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16395 if (last_text_row)
16397 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16398 w->window_end_bytepos
16399 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16400 wset_window_end_pos
16401 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16402 wset_window_end_vpos
16403 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix)));
16404 eassert
16405 (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16406 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))->displays_text_p);
16408 else
16410 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16411 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16412 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16415 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16416 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16417 return 1;
16422 /************************************************************************
16423 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16424 ************************************************************************/
16426 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16427 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16428 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16429 W->start is the new window start. */
16431 static int
16432 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16434 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16435 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16436 struct it it;
16437 struct run run;
16438 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16439 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16440 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16441 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16442 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16443 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16445 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16446 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16447 return 0;
16448 #endif
16450 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16451 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16452 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16453 or such. */
16454 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16455 || cursor_type_changed)
16456 return 0;
16458 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16459 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16460 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16461 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16462 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16463 return 0;
16465 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16466 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16467 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16468 return 0;
16470 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16471 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16472 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16473 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16474 return 0;
16476 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16477 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16478 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16479 start = start_row->minpos;
16480 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16482 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16483 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16485 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16487 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16488 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16489 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16490 not a frequent case. */
16491 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16492 return 0;
16494 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16496 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16497 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16498 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16499 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16500 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16501 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16502 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16504 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16505 && !fonts_changed_p)
16507 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16508 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16509 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16510 work to start copying with the following row. */
16511 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16513 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16514 start_row++;
16515 start = start_row->minpos;
16516 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16517 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16518 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16519 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16521 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16522 return 0;
16525 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16527 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16528 rows. */
16529 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16530 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16531 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16532 that same display vector (thus their character
16533 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16534 that is the case. */
16535 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16536 break;
16538 if (display_line (&it))
16539 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16543 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16544 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16545 have at least one reusable row. */
16546 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16548 struct glyph_row *row;
16550 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16551 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16553 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16554 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16556 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16558 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16559 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16560 if (row)
16561 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16562 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16563 else
16565 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16566 return 0;
16570 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16571 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16572 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16573 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16574 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16575 in. */
16576 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16577 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16578 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16580 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16582 update_begin (f);
16583 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16584 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16585 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16586 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16587 update_end (f);
16590 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16591 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16592 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16593 start_vpos,
16594 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16595 nrows_scrolled);
16597 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16598 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16599 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16601 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16602 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16603 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16604 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16605 row < bottom_row;
16606 ++row)
16608 row->y = it.current_y;
16609 row->visible_height = row->height;
16611 if (row->y < min_y)
16612 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16613 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16614 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16615 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16616 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16618 it.current_y += row->height;
16620 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16621 last_reused_text_row = row;
16622 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16623 break;
16626 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16627 below the window. */
16628 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16629 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16632 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16633 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16634 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16635 containing text. */
16636 if (last_reused_text_row)
16638 w->window_end_bytepos
16639 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16640 wset_window_end_pos
16641 (w, make_number (Z
16642 - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row)));
16643 wset_window_end_vpos
16644 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16645 w->current_matrix)));
16647 else if (last_text_row)
16649 w->window_end_bytepos
16650 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16651 wset_window_end_pos
16652 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16653 wset_window_end_vpos
16654 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16655 w->desired_matrix)));
16657 else
16659 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16660 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16661 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16662 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16664 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16666 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16667 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16669 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16670 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16671 #endif
16672 return 1;
16674 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16676 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16677 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16678 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16679 int dy;
16680 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16682 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16683 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16684 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16685 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16686 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16687 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16688 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16689 ++first_reusable_row;
16691 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16692 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16693 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16694 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16695 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16696 return 0;
16698 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16699 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16700 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16701 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16702 pt_row = NULL;
16703 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16704 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16705 ++first_row_to_display)
16707 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16708 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16709 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16710 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16711 && pt_row == NULL)))
16712 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16715 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16716 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16717 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16719 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16720 - start_vpos);
16721 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16722 - nrows_scrolled);
16723 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16724 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16726 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16727 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16728 that displays text. */
16729 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16730 if (pt_row == NULL)
16731 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16732 last_text_row = NULL;
16733 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16734 if (display_line (&it))
16735 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16737 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16738 position. */
16739 if (pt_row)
16741 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16742 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16745 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16746 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16747 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16748 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16749 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16751 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16752 return 0;
16755 /* Scroll the display. */
16756 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16757 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16758 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16759 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16761 if (run.height)
16763 update_begin (f);
16764 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16765 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16766 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16767 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16768 update_end (f);
16771 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16772 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16773 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16774 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16775 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16777 row->y -= dy;
16778 row->visible_height = row->height;
16779 if (row->y < min_y)
16780 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16781 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16782 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16783 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16784 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16787 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16788 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16789 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16790 start_vpos,
16791 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16792 -nrows_scrolled);
16794 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16795 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16796 row->enabled_p = 0;
16798 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16799 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16800 if (pt_row)
16802 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16803 row < bottom_row
16804 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16805 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16806 row++)
16808 w->cursor.vpos++;
16809 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16811 if (row < bottom_row)
16813 /* Can't simply scan the row for point with
16814 bidi-reordered glyph rows. Let set_cursor_from_row
16815 figure out where to put the cursor, and if it fails,
16816 give up. */
16817 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16819 if (!set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
16820 0, 0, 0, 0))
16822 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16823 return 0;
16826 else
16828 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16829 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16831 for (; glyph < end
16832 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16833 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16834 glyph++)
16836 w->cursor.hpos++;
16837 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16843 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16844 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16845 only its vpos can have changed. */
16846 if (last_text_row)
16848 w->window_end_bytepos
16849 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16850 wset_window_end_pos
16851 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16852 wset_window_end_vpos
16853 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16854 w->desired_matrix)));
16856 else
16858 wset_window_end_vpos
16859 (w, make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled));
16862 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16863 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16865 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16866 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16867 #endif
16868 return 1;
16871 return 0;
16876 /************************************************************************
16877 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16878 ************************************************************************/
16880 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16881 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16882 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
16883 static struct glyph_row *
16884 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16885 struct glyph_row *);
16888 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16889 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16890 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16891 a pointer to the row found. */
16893 static struct glyph_row *
16894 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16895 struct glyph_row *start)
16897 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16899 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16900 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16901 visible lines. */
16902 row_found = NULL;
16903 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16904 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16906 eassert (row->enabled_p);
16907 row_found = row;
16908 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16909 break;
16910 ++row;
16913 return row_found;
16917 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16918 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16919 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16921 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16922 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16923 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16924 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16925 when the current matrix was built. */
16927 static struct glyph_row *
16928 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16930 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16931 struct glyph_row *row;
16932 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16933 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16935 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16936 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16937 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16938 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16939 ++row)
16941 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16942 except in some case. */
16943 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16944 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16945 unchanged. */
16946 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16947 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16948 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16949 continued. */
16950 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16951 && (row->continued_p
16952 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
16953 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
16954 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
16955 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
16956 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
16957 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
16958 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
16959 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
16960 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
16961 row_found = row;
16963 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16964 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16965 break;
16968 return row_found;
16972 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16973 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16974 time W's current matrix was built.
16976 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16977 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16979 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16981 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16982 changes. */
16984 static struct glyph_row *
16985 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16986 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
16988 struct glyph_row *row;
16989 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16991 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16993 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16994 is not up to date. */
16995 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16997 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16998 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16999 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
17000 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
17001 return NULL;
17003 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
17004 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17006 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
17007 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17009 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
17010 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
17011 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
17012 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
17013 positions for characters not in changed text. */
17014 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
17015 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17016 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
17017 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17018 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
17019 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
17020 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
17022 *delta = Z - Z_old;
17023 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17025 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
17026 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
17027 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
17028 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
17029 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
17030 position. */
17031 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
17032 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
17034 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
17035 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
17036 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
17038 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
17039 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
17040 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17041 break;
17043 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
17044 row_found = row;
17048 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
17050 return row_found;
17054 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
17055 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
17056 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
17057 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
17058 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17060 static void
17061 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17063 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17064 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17066 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17067 must have a frame matrix. */
17068 eassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
17069 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17070 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17072 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17073 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17074 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17075 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17076 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17077 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17078 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17079 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17081 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17082 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17084 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17085 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17086 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17087 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17089 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17090 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17091 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17092 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
17094 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17099 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17100 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17101 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17102 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17104 struct glyph_row *
17105 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17106 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17108 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17109 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17110 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
17111 int last_y;
17113 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17114 if (row->mode_line_p)
17115 ++row;
17117 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17118 return NULL;
17120 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17122 while (1)
17124 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17125 if (end && row >= end)
17126 return NULL;
17127 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17128 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17129 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17130 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17131 return NULL;
17133 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17134 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17135 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17136 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17137 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17138 would rather display it in the next line, except
17139 when this line ends in ZV. */
17140 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17141 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
17142 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17144 struct glyph *g;
17146 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17147 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17148 return row;
17149 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
17150 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
17151 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
17152 CHARPOS the best. */
17153 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17154 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17155 g++)
17157 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17159 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17161 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17162 best_row = row;
17163 /* Exact match always wins. */
17164 if (mindif == 0)
17165 return best_row;
17170 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17171 return best_row;
17172 ++row;
17177 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17178 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17179 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
17181 Value is
17183 1 if display has been updated
17184 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17185 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17187 The following steps are performed:
17189 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17190 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17191 is found, give up.
17193 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17194 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17196 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17197 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17198 the window.
17200 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17202 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17203 display and current matrix as needed.
17205 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17206 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17207 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17208 in smaller font sizes.
17210 7. Update W's window end information. */
17212 static int
17213 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17215 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17216 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17217 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17218 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17219 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17220 struct glyph_row *row;
17221 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17222 int bottom_vpos;
17223 struct it it;
17224 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17225 int dvpos, dy;
17226 struct text_pos start_pos;
17227 struct run run;
17228 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17229 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17230 struct text_pos start;
17231 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17233 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17234 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17235 return 0;
17236 #endif
17238 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17239 #if 0
17240 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17241 do { \
17242 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17243 return 0; \
17244 } while (0)
17245 #else
17246 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17247 #endif
17249 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17251 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17252 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17253 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17254 GIVE_UP (1);
17256 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17257 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
17258 GIVE_UP (2);
17260 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17261 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17262 It would be nice to further
17263 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17264 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17265 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17266 GIVE_UP (3);
17268 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17269 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17270 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17271 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17272 GIVE_UP (4);
17274 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17275 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17276 GIVE_UP (5);
17278 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17279 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17280 GIVE_UP (6);
17282 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17283 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17284 GIVE_UP (7);
17286 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17287 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
17288 GIVE_UP (8);
17290 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
17291 will do more than just set the cursor. */
17292 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
17293 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
17294 GIVE_UP (9);
17296 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17297 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17298 GIVE_UP (11);
17300 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
17301 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
17302 GIVE_UP (10);
17304 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17305 changed. */
17306 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17307 GIVE_UP (12);
17309 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17310 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17311 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17312 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17313 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
17314 GIVE_UP (21);
17316 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17317 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17318 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17319 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17320 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17321 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17322 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17323 redisplay from scratch. */
17324 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17325 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17326 GIVE_UP (22);
17328 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17329 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17330 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17331 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17332 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17333 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17334 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17336 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17337 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17338 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17339 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17342 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17343 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17344 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17346 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17347 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17348 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17349 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17350 be adjusted, of course. */
17351 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17352 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17353 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17354 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17355 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17356 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17358 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17359 struct glyph_row *r0;
17361 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17362 from the buffer. */
17363 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17364 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17365 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17366 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17368 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17369 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17370 front of the window start. */
17371 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17372 GIVE_UP (13);
17374 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17375 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17376 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17377 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17378 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17379 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17380 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17381 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17382 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17384 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17385 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17387 struct glyph_row *r1
17388 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17389 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17390 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17391 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17392 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17395 /* Set the cursor. */
17396 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17397 if (row)
17398 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17399 else
17400 emacs_abort ();
17401 return 1;
17405 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17406 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17407 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17408 there that is visible in the window. */
17409 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17410 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17411 changes at ZV, actually. */
17412 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17413 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17415 struct glyph_row *r0;
17417 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17418 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17419 front of the window start. */
17420 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17421 GIVE_UP (14);
17423 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17424 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17425 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17426 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17427 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17428 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17429 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17430 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17432 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17433 could have been added/removed after it. */
17434 wset_window_end_pos
17435 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17436 w->window_end_bytepos
17437 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17439 /* Set the cursor. */
17440 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17441 if (row)
17442 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17443 else
17444 emacs_abort ();
17445 return 2;
17449 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17451 The condition used to read
17453 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17455 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17456 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17457 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17458 GIVE_UP (15);
17460 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17461 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17462 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17463 comparable. */
17464 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17465 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17466 GIVE_UP (16);
17468 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17469 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17470 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17471 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17472 GIVE_UP (20);
17474 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17475 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17476 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17477 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17478 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17479 first line of window. */
17480 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17481 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17483 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17484 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17485 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17486 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17487 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17488 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17489 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17490 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17492 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17493 GIVE_UP (17);
17495 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17496 GIVE_UP (18);
17497 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17499 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17500 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17501 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17502 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17503 current_matrix);
17504 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17505 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17507 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17509 else
17511 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17512 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17513 start_display (&it, w, start);
17514 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17515 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17518 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17519 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17520 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17521 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17522 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17523 changes. */
17524 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17525 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17526 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17527 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17529 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17530 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17531 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17532 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17533 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17534 stop_pos = 0;
17535 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17537 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17538 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17540 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17541 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17542 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17543 not displaying text. */
17544 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17545 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17546 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17547 < it.last_visible_y))
17548 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17550 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17551 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17552 >= it.last_visible_y))
17553 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17554 else
17556 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17557 + delta);
17558 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17559 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17560 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17563 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17564 GIVE_UP (19);
17567 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17569 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17570 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17571 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17572 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17573 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17575 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17576 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17577 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17578 : -1);
17579 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17581 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17584 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17585 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17586 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17587 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17588 last_text_row = NULL;
17589 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17590 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17591 && !fonts_changed_p
17592 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17593 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17595 if (display_line (&it))
17596 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17599 if (fonts_changed_p)
17600 return -1;
17603 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17604 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17605 scroll. */
17606 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17607 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17608 bottom of the window. */
17609 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17611 dvpos = (it.vpos
17612 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17613 current_matrix));
17614 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17615 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17616 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17617 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17619 else
17621 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17622 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17623 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17625 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17628 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17629 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17630 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17631 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17632 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17633 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17634 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17635 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17636 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17638 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17639 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17640 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17642 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17643 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17644 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17645 if (row)
17646 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17649 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17650 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17652 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17653 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17654 if (row)
17655 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17656 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17659 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17660 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17662 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17663 return -1;
17667 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17669 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17671 this_scroll_margin =
17672 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17673 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17674 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17676 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17677 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17678 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17679 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17680 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17681 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17682 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17684 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17685 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17686 return -1;
17690 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17691 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17692 found. */
17693 if (dy && run.height)
17695 update_begin (f);
17697 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17699 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17700 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17701 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17702 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17704 else
17706 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17707 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17708 int from_vpos
17709 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17710 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17711 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17712 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17713 + window_internal_height (w));
17715 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17716 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17717 #endif
17718 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17719 if (dvpos > 0)
17721 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17722 window down dvpos lines. */
17723 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17725 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17726 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17727 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17728 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17730 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17731 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17732 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17734 else if (dvpos < 0)
17736 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17737 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17738 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17740 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17741 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17742 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17743 line sequences. */
17744 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17746 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17747 end. */
17748 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17749 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17752 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17755 update_end (f);
17758 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17759 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17760 text. */
17761 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17762 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17763 if (dvpos < 0)
17765 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17766 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17767 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17768 bottom_vpos);
17770 else if (dvpos > 0)
17772 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17773 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17774 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17775 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos);
17778 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17779 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17780 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17781 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17783 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17784 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17785 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17786 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17787 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17789 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17790 if (dy)
17791 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17792 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17793 bottom_vpos, dy);
17795 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17797 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17798 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17799 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17800 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17803 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17804 the window. */
17805 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17806 if (dy < 0)
17808 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17809 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17810 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17811 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17812 the matrix by dvpos. */
17813 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17814 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17816 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17817 eassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17819 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17820 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17821 line following it. */
17822 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17824 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17825 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17826 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17828 else
17830 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17831 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17832 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17833 ++last_row;
17836 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17837 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17838 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17839 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17841 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17842 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17843 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17844 && !fonts_changed_p)
17846 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17847 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17848 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17849 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17850 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17851 if (display_line (&it))
17852 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17856 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17857 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17858 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17860 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17861 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17862 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17863 scrolling. */
17864 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17865 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17866 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17867 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17869 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17870 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17871 wset_window_end_vpos
17872 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix)));
17873 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17874 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17876 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17878 wset_window_end_pos
17879 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end)));
17880 w->window_end_bytepos
17881 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17882 wset_window_end_vpos
17883 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end,
17884 desired_matrix)));
17885 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17886 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17888 else if (last_text_row)
17890 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17891 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17892 in the desired matrix. */
17893 wset_window_end_pos
17894 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
17895 w->window_end_bytepos
17896 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17897 wset_window_end_vpos
17898 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix)));
17899 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17901 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17902 && last_text_row == NULL
17903 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17905 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17906 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17907 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17908 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17909 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17910 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17912 for (row = NULL;
17913 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17914 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17916 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17918 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17919 row = desired_row;
17921 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17922 row = current_row;
17925 eassert (row != NULL);
17926 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (vpos + 1));
17927 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17928 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17929 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17930 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17932 else
17933 emacs_abort ();
17935 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17936 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17938 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17939 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
17940 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17941 return 3;
17943 #undef GIVE_UP
17948 /***********************************************************************
17949 More debugging support
17950 ***********************************************************************/
17952 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17954 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17955 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17956 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17959 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17961 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17962 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17963 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17965 void
17966 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17968 int i;
17969 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17970 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17974 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17975 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17977 void
17978 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17980 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17982 fprintf (stderr,
17983 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17984 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17985 'C',
17986 glyph->charpos,
17987 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17988 ? 'B'
17989 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17990 ? 'S'
17991 : '-')),
17992 glyph->pixel_width,
17993 glyph->u.ch,
17994 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17995 ? glyph->u.ch
17996 : '.'),
17997 glyph->face_id,
17998 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17999 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18001 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18003 fprintf (stderr,
18004 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18005 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18006 'S',
18007 glyph->charpos,
18008 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18009 ? 'B'
18010 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18011 ? 'S'
18012 : '-')),
18013 glyph->pixel_width,
18015 '.',
18016 glyph->face_id,
18017 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18018 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18020 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
18022 fprintf (stderr,
18023 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18024 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18025 'I',
18026 glyph->charpos,
18027 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18028 ? 'B'
18029 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18030 ? 'S'
18031 : '-')),
18032 glyph->pixel_width,
18033 glyph->u.img_id,
18034 '.',
18035 glyph->face_id,
18036 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18037 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18039 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
18041 fprintf (stderr,
18042 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
18043 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18044 '+',
18045 glyph->charpos,
18046 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18047 ? 'B'
18048 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18049 ? 'S'
18050 : '-')),
18051 glyph->pixel_width,
18052 glyph->u.cmp.id);
18053 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
18054 fprintf (stderr,
18055 "[%d-%d]",
18056 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
18057 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18058 glyph->face_id,
18059 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18060 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18065 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18066 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18067 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18068 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18070 void
18071 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18073 if (glyphs != 1)
18075 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18076 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
18078 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18079 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18080 vpos,
18081 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18082 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18083 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18084 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18085 row->enabled_p,
18086 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18087 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18088 row->continued_p,
18089 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18090 row->displays_text_p,
18091 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18092 row->fill_line_p,
18093 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18094 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18095 row->mouse_face_p,
18096 row->x,
18097 row->y,
18098 row->pixel_width,
18099 row->height,
18100 row->visible_height,
18101 row->ascent,
18102 row->phys_ascent);
18103 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pD"d %5"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18104 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18105 row->continuation_lines_width);
18106 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
18107 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18108 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18109 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18110 row->end.dpvec_index);
18113 if (glyphs > 1)
18115 int area;
18117 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18119 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18120 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18122 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18123 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18124 ++glyph_end;
18126 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18127 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18129 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18130 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18133 else if (glyphs == 1)
18135 int area;
18137 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18139 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
18140 int i;
18142 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18144 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18145 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18146 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18147 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18148 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18149 else
18150 s[i] = '.';
18153 s[i] = '\0';
18154 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18160 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18161 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18162 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18163 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18164 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18165 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18166 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18168 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18169 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18171 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18172 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18173 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18174 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18175 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18176 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18177 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18178 return Qnil;
18182 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18183 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18184 (void)
18186 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18187 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18188 return Qnil;
18192 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18193 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18194 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18195 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18196 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18197 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18199 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18200 EMACS_INT vpos;
18202 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18203 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18204 vpos = XINT (row);
18205 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18206 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18207 vpos,
18208 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18209 return Qnil;
18213 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18214 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18215 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18216 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18217 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18218 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18220 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18221 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18222 EMACS_INT vpos;
18224 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18225 vpos = XINT (row);
18226 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18227 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18228 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18229 return Qnil;
18233 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18234 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18235 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18236 (Lisp_Object arg)
18238 if (NILP (arg))
18239 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18240 else
18242 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18243 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18246 return Qnil;
18250 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18251 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18252 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18253 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18255 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18256 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18257 return Qnil;
18260 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18264 /***********************************************************************
18265 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18266 ***********************************************************************/
18268 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18269 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18271 static struct glyph_row *
18272 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18274 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18275 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18276 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18277 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18278 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18279 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18280 const unsigned char *p;
18281 struct it it;
18282 int multibyte_p;
18283 int n_glyphs_before;
18285 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18286 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18287 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18288 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18290 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18291 p = arrow_string;
18292 while (p < arrow_end)
18294 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18296 /* Get the next character. */
18297 if (multibyte_p)
18298 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18299 else
18301 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18302 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18303 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18305 p += it.len;
18307 /* Get its face. */
18308 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18309 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18310 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18312 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18313 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18314 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18315 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18317 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18318 to remove some glyphs. */
18319 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18321 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18322 break;
18326 set_buffer_temp (old);
18327 return it.glyph_row;
18331 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18332 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18334 static void
18335 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18337 struct it truncate_it;
18338 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18340 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18341 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18342 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18343 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18344 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18346 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18347 truncate_it = *it;
18348 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18349 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18350 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18351 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18352 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18353 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18354 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18356 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18357 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18359 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18361 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18362 end = from + tused;
18363 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18364 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18365 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18367 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18368 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18369 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18370 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18371 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18372 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18373 the right. */
18374 int w = 0;
18375 struct glyph *g = to;
18376 short used;
18378 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18379 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18380 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18381 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18382 will begin. */
18383 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18384 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18386 w += g->pixel_width;
18387 ++g;
18389 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18391 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18392 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18394 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18395 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18396 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18397 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18398 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18400 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18402 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18406 while (from < end)
18407 *to++ = *from++;
18409 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18410 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18412 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18414 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18415 while (from < end)
18416 *to++ = *from++;
18420 if (to > toend)
18421 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18423 else
18425 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18427 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18428 that back to front. */
18429 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18430 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18431 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18432 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18433 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18435 int w = 0;
18436 struct glyph *g = to;
18438 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18440 w += g->pixel_width;
18441 --g;
18443 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18444 to = g + tused;
18445 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18446 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18447 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18449 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18451 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18455 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18456 *to-- = *from--;
18457 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18459 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18461 from =
18462 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18463 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18464 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18465 *to-- = *from--;
18468 if (from >= end)
18470 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18471 glyphs. */
18472 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18473 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18474 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18476 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18477 g[move_by] = *g;
18478 while (from >= end)
18479 *to-- = *from--;
18480 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18485 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18486 unsigned
18487 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18489 int area, k;
18490 unsigned hashval = 0;
18492 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18493 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18494 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18495 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18496 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18497 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18498 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18500 return hashval;
18503 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18505 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18506 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18507 structure. This is not the case if
18509 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18510 and max_height will be zero.
18512 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18513 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18514 pixmap extensions).
18516 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18517 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18518 must not be zero. */
18520 static void
18521 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18523 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18525 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18527 int i, min_y, max_y;
18529 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18530 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18531 computed yet. */
18532 if (row->height == 0)
18534 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18535 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18536 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18537 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18538 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18539 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18540 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18543 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18544 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18545 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18546 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18548 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18549 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18551 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18552 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18554 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18555 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18556 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18557 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18558 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18560 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18561 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18564 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18565 row->visible_height = row->height;
18567 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18568 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18570 if (row->y < min_y)
18571 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18572 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18573 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18575 else
18577 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18578 if (row->continued_p)
18579 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18580 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18581 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18582 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18583 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18584 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18587 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18588 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18590 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18591 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18595 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18596 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18597 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18599 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18600 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18601 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18602 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18604 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18605 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18607 static int
18608 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18610 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18612 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18614 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18615 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18617 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18618 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18619 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18620 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18621 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18622 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18623 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18624 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18625 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18626 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18627 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18628 struct face *face;
18630 saved_object = it->object;
18631 saved_pos = it->position;
18633 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18634 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18635 it->object = make_number (0);
18636 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18637 it->len = 1;
18639 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18640 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18641 if (default_face_p)
18642 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18643 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18644 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18645 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18646 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18648 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18650 it->override_ascent = -1;
18651 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18652 it->current_x = saved_x;
18653 it->object = saved_object;
18654 it->position = saved_pos;
18655 it->what = saved_what;
18656 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18657 it->len = saved_len;
18658 it->c = saved_c;
18659 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18660 return 1;
18664 return 0;
18668 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18669 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18670 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18671 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18672 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18673 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18675 static void
18676 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18678 struct face *face, *default_face;
18679 struct frame *f = it->f;
18681 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18682 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18683 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18684 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18685 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18686 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18687 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18688 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18689 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18690 return;
18692 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18693 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18695 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18696 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18697 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18698 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18699 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18700 else
18701 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18703 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18704 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18705 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18706 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18707 && !face->stipple
18708 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18709 return;
18711 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18712 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18713 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18715 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18716 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18717 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18718 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18719 text. */
18720 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18722 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18725 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18727 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18728 so that we know which face to draw. */
18729 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18731 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18732 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18733 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18735 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18736 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18738 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18739 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18740 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18741 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18742 glyphs. */
18743 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18744 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18745 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18746 struct glyph *g;
18747 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18748 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18749 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18751 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18752 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18753 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18754 if (stretch_width > 0)
18756 stretch_ascent =
18757 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18758 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18759 saved_pos = it->position;
18760 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18761 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18762 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18763 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18764 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18765 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18766 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18767 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18768 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18769 else
18770 it->face_id = face->id;
18771 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18772 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18773 it->position = saved_pos;
18774 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18775 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18778 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18780 else
18782 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18783 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18784 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18785 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18786 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18787 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18789 saved_object = it->object;
18790 saved_pos = it->position;
18792 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18793 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18794 it->object = make_number (0);
18795 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18796 it->len = 1;
18797 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18798 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18799 if the region ends at ZV. */
18800 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18801 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18802 else
18803 it->face_id = face->id;
18805 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18807 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18808 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18810 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18811 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18812 it->current_x = saved_x;
18813 it->object = saved_object;
18814 it->position = saved_pos;
18815 it->what = saved_what;
18816 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18821 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18822 trailing whitespace. */
18824 static int
18825 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18827 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18828 int c = 0;
18830 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18831 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18832 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18833 ++bytepos;
18835 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18837 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18838 return 1;
18840 return 0;
18844 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18846 static void
18847 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18849 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18851 if (used)
18853 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18854 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18856 if (row->reversed_p)
18858 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18859 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18860 glyph = start;
18861 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18864 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18865 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18866 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18867 and continuation glyphs. */
18868 if (!row->reversed_p)
18870 while (glyph >= start
18871 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18872 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18873 --glyph;
18875 else
18877 while (glyph <= start
18878 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18879 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18880 ++glyph;
18883 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18884 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18885 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18886 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18887 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18888 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18889 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18890 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18891 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18893 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18894 if (face_id < 0)
18895 return;
18897 if (!row->reversed_p)
18899 while (glyph >= start
18900 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18901 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18902 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18903 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18904 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18906 else
18908 while (glyph <= start
18909 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18910 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18911 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18912 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18913 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18920 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18921 used to hold the cursor. */
18923 static int
18924 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18926 int result = 1;
18928 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18929 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18931 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18932 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18933 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18934 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18935 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18936 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
18937 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
18938 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
18939 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18941 if (row->continued_p)
18942 result = 1;
18943 else
18945 /* Check for `display' property. */
18946 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18947 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18948 struct glyph *glyph;
18950 result = 0;
18951 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18952 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18954 Lisp_Object prop
18955 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18956 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18957 result =
18958 (!NILP (prop)
18959 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18960 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
18961 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
18962 even though this is not a display string. */
18963 if (!result)
18965 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
18967 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
18969 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
18971 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
18972 Qcursor, s)))
18974 result = 1;
18975 break;
18979 break;
18983 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18985 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18986 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18987 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18988 PT if PT is before the character. */
18989 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18990 result = row->continued_p;
18991 else
18992 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18993 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18994 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18995 after the ellipsis. */
18996 result = 0;
18998 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18999 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
19000 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19001 result = 1;
19002 else
19003 result = 0;
19006 return result;
19011 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
19012 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
19013 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
19014 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
19016 static int
19017 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19019 struct text_pos pos =
19020 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
19022 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
19023 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19024 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
19026 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
19027 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
19028 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
19029 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
19030 push_it (it, &pos);
19032 if (STRINGP (prop))
19034 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
19036 pop_it (it);
19037 return 0;
19040 it->string = prop;
19041 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
19042 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
19043 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
19044 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
19045 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
19046 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
19047 it->stop_charpos = 0;
19048 it->prev_stop = 0;
19049 it->base_level_stop = 0;
19051 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
19052 buffer/string. */
19053 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
19054 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
19055 else
19056 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19058 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19059 if (it->bidi_p)
19061 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19062 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19063 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19064 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19065 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19066 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19067 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19070 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19072 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19073 it->object = prop;
19075 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19076 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19078 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19079 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19080 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19082 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19083 else
19085 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19086 return 0;
19089 return 1;
19092 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19094 static Lisp_Object
19095 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19097 Lisp_Object position;
19099 if (STRINGP (it->object))
19100 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19101 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
19102 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19103 else
19104 return Qnil;
19106 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
19109 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19111 static void
19112 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19114 Lisp_Object prefix;
19116 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19118 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19119 if (NILP (prefix))
19120 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19122 else
19124 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19125 if (NILP (prefix))
19126 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19128 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19130 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19131 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19132 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19133 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19134 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19140 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19141 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19142 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19143 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19144 static void
19145 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19147 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19149 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19150 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19151 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19152 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19154 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19155 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19156 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19157 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19158 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19159 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19162 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19163 and ROW->maxpos. */
19164 static void
19165 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19166 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19167 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19169 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19170 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19172 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19173 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19174 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19175 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19176 else
19177 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19178 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19179 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19180 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19181 if (max_pos <= 0)
19183 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19184 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19187 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19188 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19190 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19191 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19192 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19193 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19194 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19195 Line is continued from string max_pos
19196 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19197 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19198 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19199 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19201 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19202 appropriate. */
19203 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19204 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19205 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19207 int seen_this_string = 0;
19208 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19210 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19211 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19212 /* this is not the first row */
19213 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19214 /* previous row is not the header line */
19215 && !r1->mode_line_p
19216 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19217 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19219 struct glyph *start, *end;
19221 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19222 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19223 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19224 other way round. */
19225 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19227 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19228 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19229 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19230 as their object. */
19231 while (end > start
19232 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19233 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19234 --end;
19235 if (end > start)
19237 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19238 seen_this_string = 1;
19240 else
19241 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19242 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19243 produced from a single newline, which is only
19244 possible if that newline came from the same string
19245 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19246 seen_this_string = 1;
19248 else
19250 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19251 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19252 while (end < start
19253 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19254 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19255 ++end;
19256 if (end < start)
19258 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19259 seen_this_string = 1;
19261 else
19262 seen_this_string = 1;
19265 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19266 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19267 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19268 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19270 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19271 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19272 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19273 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19274 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19275 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19276 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19277 have a much larger value. */
19278 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19279 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19280 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19282 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19283 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19284 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19285 else if (row->continued_p)
19287 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19288 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19289 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19290 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19291 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19292 starts at the next buffer position. */
19293 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19294 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19295 else
19297 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19298 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19301 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19302 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19303 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19304 the logical order. */
19305 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19306 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19307 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19308 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19309 else
19310 emacs_abort ();
19312 else
19313 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19316 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19317 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19318 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19319 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19320 only. */
19322 static int
19323 display_line (struct it *it)
19325 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19326 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19327 struct it wrap_it;
19328 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19329 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19330 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19331 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19332 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19333 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19334 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19335 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19336 int cvpos;
19337 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19338 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19340 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19341 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19343 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19344 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19346 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19347 fonts_changed_p = 1;
19348 return 0;
19351 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
19352 wset_region_showing (it->w, it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
19354 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19355 prepare_desired_row (row);
19357 row->y = it->current_y;
19358 row->start = it->start;
19359 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19360 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19361 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19362 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19364 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19365 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19366 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19367 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19368 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19369 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19371 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19372 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19373 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19374 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19376 enum move_it_result move_result;
19378 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19379 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19380 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19381 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19382 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19383 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19384 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19385 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19386 blank glyphs to produce. */
19387 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19388 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19389 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19390 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19392 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19393 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19394 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19395 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19396 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19397 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19398 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19399 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19400 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19402 else
19404 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19405 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19406 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19407 handle_line_prefix (it);
19410 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19411 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19412 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19413 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19414 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19415 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19416 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19418 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19419 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19420 do \
19422 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19423 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19424 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19425 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19426 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19427 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19428 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19429 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19430 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19432 min_pos = current_pos; \
19433 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19435 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19437 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19438 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19441 while (0)
19443 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19444 character to display. */
19445 while (1)
19447 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19448 int x, nglyphs;
19449 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19451 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19452 buffer reached. */
19453 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19455 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19456 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19457 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19458 to -1. */
19459 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19460 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19461 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19462 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19464 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19465 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19467 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
19468 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19469 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19470 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19473 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19474 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19475 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19476 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19477 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19478 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19479 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19480 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19481 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19482 background color. */
19483 if (row->reversed_p
19484 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19485 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19486 break;
19489 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19490 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19491 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19492 x = it->current_x;
19494 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19495 fit on the line. */
19496 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19498 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19499 descent = it->max_descent;
19500 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19501 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19503 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19505 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19506 may_wrap = 1;
19507 else if (may_wrap)
19509 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19510 wrap_x = x;
19511 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19512 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19513 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19514 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19515 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19516 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19517 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19518 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19519 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19520 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19521 may_wrap = 0;
19526 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19528 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19529 the next one. */
19530 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19532 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19533 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19534 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19535 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19536 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19537 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19538 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19539 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19540 continue;
19543 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19544 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19545 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19546 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19547 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19548 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19549 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19550 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19551 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19552 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19553 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19554 x_before = x;
19556 if (/* Not a newline. */
19557 nglyphs > 0
19558 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19559 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19561 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19562 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19563 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19564 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19565 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19566 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19567 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19568 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19569 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19570 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19571 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19572 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19573 if (it->bidi_p)
19574 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19576 else
19578 int i, new_x;
19579 struct glyph *glyph;
19581 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19583 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19584 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19586 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19587 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19588 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19589 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19590 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19591 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19592 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19593 && (row->reversed_p
19594 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19595 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19597 /* End of a continued line. */
19599 if (it->hpos == 0
19600 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19601 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19602 && (row->reversed_p
19603 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19604 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19606 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19607 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19608 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19609 after the glyph. */
19610 row->continued_p = 1;
19611 it->current_x = new_x;
19612 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19613 ++it->hpos;
19614 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19616 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19617 wrap point was found. */
19618 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19619 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19620 point, continue the line here as
19621 usual, if (i) the previous character
19622 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19623 current character is not. */
19624 && (!may_wrap
19625 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19626 goto back_to_wrap;
19628 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19629 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19630 displayed by this row. */
19631 if (it->bidi_p)
19632 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19633 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19634 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19636 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19638 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19639 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19640 row->continued_p = 0;
19641 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19643 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19645 row->continued_p = 0;
19646 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19650 else if (it->bidi_p)
19651 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19653 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19654 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19656 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19657 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19658 on the line. */
19659 if (row->reversed_p)
19660 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19661 - n_glyphs_before);
19662 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19664 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19665 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19666 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19667 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19668 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19670 row->continued_p = 1;
19671 it->current_x = x_before;
19672 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19674 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19675 element not fitting on the line. */
19676 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19677 it->max_descent = descent;
19678 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19679 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19681 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19683 back_to_wrap:
19684 if (row->reversed_p)
19685 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19686 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19687 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19688 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19689 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19690 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19691 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19692 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19693 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19694 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19695 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19696 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19697 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19698 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19699 row->continued_p = 1;
19700 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19701 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19702 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19704 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19705 up to the right margin of the window. */
19706 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19708 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19710 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19711 window. This produces a single glyph on
19712 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19713 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19714 consume the TAB. */
19715 if ((row->reversed_p
19716 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19717 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19718 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19719 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19720 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19721 row->continued_p = 1;
19722 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19723 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19725 else
19727 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19728 the right edge of the window. Restore
19729 positions to values before the element. */
19730 if (row->reversed_p)
19731 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19732 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19733 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19735 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19736 it->current_x = x_before;
19737 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19738 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19739 || (row->reversed_p
19740 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19741 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19742 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19743 row->continued_p = 1;
19745 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19747 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19749 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19750 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19753 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19754 element not fitting on the line. */
19755 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19756 it->max_descent = descent;
19757 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19758 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19761 break;
19763 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19765 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19766 ++it->hpos;
19768 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19769 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19770 this row. */
19771 if (it->bidi_p)
19772 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19774 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19775 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19776 negative X position. */
19777 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19779 else
19781 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19782 window. This should not happen because of the
19783 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19784 function, unless the text display area of the
19785 window is empty. */
19786 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19789 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19790 we want to record its position. */
19791 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19792 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19794 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19795 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19796 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19797 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19798 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19799 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19800 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19802 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19803 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19804 break;
19807 at_end_of_line:
19808 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19809 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19810 margin of the window. */
19811 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19813 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19815 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19817 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19818 display the cursor there. */
19819 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19820 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19822 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19823 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19825 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19826 if (used_before == 0)
19827 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19829 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19830 find_row_edges. */
19831 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19833 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19834 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19835 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19836 break;
19839 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19840 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19841 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19843 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19844 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19845 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19846 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19847 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19848 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19850 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19851 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19852 || (row->reversed_p
19853 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19854 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19856 int i, n;
19858 if (!row->reversed_p)
19860 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19861 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19862 break;
19864 else
19866 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19867 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19868 break;
19869 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19870 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19871 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19872 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19873 last glyph added to ROW. */
19874 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19875 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19876 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19879 it->current_x = x_before;
19880 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19882 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19884 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19885 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19888 else
19890 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19891 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19894 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19896 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19897 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19899 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19900 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19901 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19902 break;
19904 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19906 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19907 goto at_end_of_line;
19909 it->current_x = x_before;
19912 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19913 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19914 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19915 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19916 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19917 break;
19921 if (wrap_data)
19922 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19924 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19925 at the left window margin. */
19926 if (it->first_visible_x
19927 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19929 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19930 || (row->reversed_p
19931 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19932 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19933 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19934 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19937 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19939 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19940 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19941 where these positions are determined. */
19942 row->end = it->current;
19943 if (!it->bidi_p)
19945 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19946 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19948 else
19950 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19951 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19952 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19953 row, so we must determine them now. */
19954 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19957 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19958 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19959 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19960 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19961 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19962 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19963 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19965 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19966 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19968 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19969 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19970 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19971 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19972 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19973 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19975 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19976 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19977 *p++ = *glyph++;
19979 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19980 p2 = p;
19981 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19982 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19983 ++p2;
19984 if (p2 > p)
19986 while (p2 < end)
19987 *p++ = *p2++;
19988 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19991 else
19993 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19994 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19996 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19999 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
20000 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
20001 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
20003 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
20004 compute_line_metrics (it);
20006 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
20007 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
20008 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
20009 structure. */
20011 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
20012 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
20013 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
20014 && it->ellipsis_p);
20016 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
20017 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
20018 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
20019 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
20020 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
20022 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20023 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20024 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20025 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20027 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
20028 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
20029 if ((cvpos < 0
20030 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
20031 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
20032 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
20033 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
20034 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
20035 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
20036 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
20037 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
20038 || (it->bidi_p
20039 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
20040 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
20041 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
20042 && cursor_row_p (row))
20043 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
20045 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
20046 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
20047 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
20048 row to be used. */
20049 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
20050 it->current_y += row->height;
20051 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
20052 ++it->vpos;
20053 ++it->glyph_row;
20054 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
20055 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
20056 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
20057 the flag accordingly. */
20058 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20059 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20060 it->start = row->end;
20061 return row->displays_text_p;
20063 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20066 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20067 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20068 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20069 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20070 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20072 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20073 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20074 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20075 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20077 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20078 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20080 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20081 struct buffer *old = buf;
20083 if (! NILP (buffer))
20085 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20086 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20089 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20090 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20091 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20092 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20093 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20094 return Qleft_to_right;
20095 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20096 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20097 else
20099 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20100 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20101 enough as it is. */
20102 struct bidi_it itb;
20103 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20104 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20105 int c;
20106 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20108 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20109 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20110 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20111 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20112 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20113 the previous non-empty line. */
20114 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20116 pos--;
20117 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
20119 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20120 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20122 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20123 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20125 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20126 break;
20127 bytepos--;
20128 pos--;
20130 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20131 bytepos--;
20133 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20134 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20135 itb.string.s = NULL;
20136 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20137 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20138 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20139 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20140 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20141 set_buffer_temp (old);
20142 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20144 case L2R:
20145 return Qleft_to_right;
20146 break;
20147 case R2L:
20148 return Qright_to_left;
20149 break;
20150 default:
20151 emacs_abort ();
20158 /***********************************************************************
20159 Menu Bar
20160 ***********************************************************************/
20162 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20164 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20165 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20167 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20168 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20169 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20170 for the menu bar. */
20172 static void
20173 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20175 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20176 struct it it;
20177 Lisp_Object items;
20178 int i;
20180 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20181 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20182 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20183 return;
20184 #endif
20185 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20186 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20187 return;
20188 #endif
20190 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20191 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20192 return;
20193 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20195 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
20196 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20197 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20198 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20199 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20200 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20201 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20203 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20204 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20205 struct window *menu_w;
20206 eassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
20207 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20208 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20209 MENU_FACE_ID);
20210 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20211 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20213 else
20215 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20216 pixel x/y. */
20217 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20218 MENU_FACE_ID);
20219 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20220 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20222 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20224 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20225 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20226 this. */
20227 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20229 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20230 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20232 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20233 clear_glyph_row (row);
20234 row->enabled_p = 1;
20235 row->full_width_p = 1;
20238 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20239 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20240 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20242 Lisp_Object string;
20244 /* Stop at nil string. */
20245 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20246 if (NILP (string))
20247 break;
20249 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20250 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20252 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20253 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20254 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20255 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20258 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20259 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20260 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20262 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20263 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20268 /***********************************************************************
20269 Mode Line
20270 ***********************************************************************/
20272 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20273 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20274 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20275 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20277 static int
20278 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
20280 int nwindows = 0;
20282 while (!NILP (window))
20284 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20286 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
20287 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
20288 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
20289 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
20290 else if (force
20291 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20292 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20294 struct text_pos lpoint;
20295 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20297 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20298 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20299 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
20301 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20302 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20303 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20305 struct text_pos pt;
20307 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20308 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
20309 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
20310 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
20311 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
20312 else
20313 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20316 /* Display mode lines. */
20317 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20318 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20320 ++nwindows;
20321 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
20324 /* Restore old settings. */
20325 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20326 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20329 window = w->next;
20332 return nwindows;
20336 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20337 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20339 static int
20340 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20342 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
20343 int n = 0;
20345 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20346 selected_frame = w->frame;
20347 old_selected_window = selected_window;
20348 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
20350 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
20351 line_number_displayed = 0;
20352 wset_column_number_displayed (w, Qnil);
20354 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
20356 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
20358 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
20359 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
20360 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
20361 ++n;
20364 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
20366 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
20367 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
20368 ++n;
20371 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
20372 selected_window = old_selected_window;
20373 return n;
20377 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
20378 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
20379 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
20380 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
20381 displayed. */
20383 static int
20384 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
20386 struct it it;
20387 struct face *face;
20388 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20390 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20391 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
20392 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
20393 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
20394 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
20396 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
20398 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
20399 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
20400 made up of many separate strings. */
20401 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20403 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20404 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
20406 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
20408 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
20409 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
20410 values. */
20411 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20412 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
20413 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20414 pop_kboard ();
20416 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20418 /* Fill up with spaces. */
20419 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
20421 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20422 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
20423 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
20424 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
20425 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
20427 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
20428 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
20429 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
20430 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
20432 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20433 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
20434 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
20437 return it.glyph_row->height;
20440 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
20441 Return the updated list. */
20443 static Lisp_Object
20444 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
20446 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
20447 register Lisp_Object tem;
20449 tail = list;
20450 prev = Qnil;
20451 while (CONSP (tail))
20453 tem = XCAR (tail);
20455 if (EQ (elt, tem))
20457 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
20458 if (NILP (prev))
20459 list = XCDR (tail);
20460 else
20461 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
20463 /* Now make it the first. */
20464 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
20465 return tail;
20467 else
20468 prev = tail;
20469 tail = XCDR (tail);
20470 QUIT;
20473 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
20474 return list;
20477 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
20478 translates into text depends on its data type.
20480 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
20482 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
20483 infinite recursion here.
20485 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
20486 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
20487 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
20488 display_string for details.
20490 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
20492 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
20494 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
20495 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
20497 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
20498 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
20499 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
20501 static int
20502 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
20503 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
20505 int n = 0, field, prec;
20506 int literal = 0;
20508 tail_recurse:
20509 if (depth > 100)
20510 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
20512 depth++;
20514 switch (XTYPE (elt))
20516 case Lisp_String:
20518 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
20519 unsigned char c;
20520 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
20522 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
20523 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
20525 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
20526 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
20528 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
20529 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
20530 is risky, do that anyway. */
20532 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
20534 /* If the starting string has properties,
20535 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
20536 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
20538 Lisp_Object tem;
20540 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
20541 tem = props;
20542 while (CONSP (tem))
20544 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
20545 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
20546 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
20548 props = oprops;
20551 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20552 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
20554 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
20555 without consing. */
20556 elt = XCAR (aelt);
20557 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20558 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20560 else
20562 Lisp_Object tem;
20564 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
20565 so get rid of it. */
20566 if (! NILP (aelt))
20567 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20568 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20570 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
20571 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
20572 props, elt);
20573 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
20574 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20575 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
20576 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20577 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
20578 to at most 50 elements. */
20579 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
20580 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20581 if (! NILP (tem))
20582 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
20587 offset = 0;
20589 if (literal)
20591 prec = precision - n;
20592 switch (mode_line_target)
20594 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20595 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20596 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
20597 break;
20598 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20599 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
20600 break;
20601 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20602 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
20603 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20604 break;
20607 break;
20610 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
20612 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
20613 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
20614 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
20615 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
20617 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
20619 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
20620 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
20623 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
20625 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
20627 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
20628 is length of string. Don't output more than
20629 PRECISION allows us. */
20630 offset--;
20632 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
20633 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
20634 &nchars, &nbytes);
20636 switch (mode_line_target)
20638 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20639 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20640 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20641 break;
20642 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20644 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20645 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20646 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
20647 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20648 : charpos + nchars);
20650 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20651 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20652 make_number (endpos)),
20653 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20655 break;
20656 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20658 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20659 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20661 if (precision <= 0)
20662 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20663 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20664 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20665 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20667 break;
20670 else /* c == '%' */
20672 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
20674 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20675 don't pad. */
20676 field = 0;
20677 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20678 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20680 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20681 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20682 field = field_width - n;
20684 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20685 prec = precision - n;
20687 if (c == 'M')
20688 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20689 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20690 risky);
20691 else if (c != 0)
20693 int multibyte;
20694 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
20695 const char *spec;
20696 Lisp_Object string;
20698 bytepos = percent_position;
20699 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20700 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20701 : bytepos);
20702 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20703 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20705 switch (mode_line_target)
20707 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20708 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20709 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20710 break;
20711 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20713 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20714 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20715 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20716 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20718 break;
20719 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20721 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20723 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20724 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20725 charpos, 0, it,
20726 field, prec, 0,
20727 multibyte);
20729 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20730 string where the `%x' came from, position
20731 of the `%'. */
20732 if (nwritten > 0)
20734 struct glyph *glyph
20735 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20736 + nglyphs_before);
20737 int i;
20739 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20741 glyph[i].object = elt;
20742 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20745 n += nwritten;
20748 break;
20751 else /* c == 0 */
20752 break;
20756 break;
20758 case Lisp_Symbol:
20759 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20760 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20761 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20762 literally. */
20764 register Lisp_Object tem;
20766 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20767 then its contents are risky to use. */
20768 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20769 risky = 1;
20771 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20772 if (!NILP (tem))
20774 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20775 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20776 don't check for % within it. */
20777 if (STRINGP (tem))
20778 literal = 1;
20780 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20782 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20783 elt = tem;
20784 goto tail_recurse;
20788 break;
20790 case Lisp_Cons:
20792 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20794 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20795 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20796 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20797 and effectively concatenate them.
20798 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20799 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20800 to at least that many characters.
20801 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20802 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20803 car = XCAR (elt);
20804 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20806 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20807 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20809 if (risky)
20810 break;
20812 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20814 Lisp_Object spec;
20815 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20816 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20817 precision - n, spec, props,
20818 risky);
20821 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20823 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20824 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20826 if (risky)
20827 break;
20829 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20830 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20831 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20832 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20834 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20836 tem = Fboundp (car);
20837 elt = XCDR (elt);
20838 if (!CONSP (elt))
20839 goto invalid;
20840 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20841 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20842 if (!NILP (tem))
20844 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20845 if (!NILP (tem))
20847 elt = XCAR (elt);
20848 goto tail_recurse;
20851 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20852 Get the cddr of the original list
20853 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20854 elt = XCDR (elt);
20855 if (NILP (elt))
20856 break;
20857 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20858 goto invalid;
20859 elt = XCAR (elt);
20860 goto tail_recurse;
20862 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20864 register int lim = XINT (car);
20865 elt = XCDR (elt);
20866 if (lim < 0)
20868 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20869 if (precision <= 0)
20870 precision = -lim;
20871 else
20872 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20874 else if (lim > 0)
20876 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20877 current maximum. */
20878 if (precision > 0)
20879 lim = min (precision, lim);
20881 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20882 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20883 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20884 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20886 goto tail_recurse;
20888 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20890 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20891 int len = 0;
20893 while (CONSP (elt)
20894 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20896 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20897 /* Do padding only after the last
20898 element in the list. */
20899 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20900 ? field_width - n
20901 : 0),
20902 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20903 props, risky);
20904 elt = XCDR (elt);
20905 len++;
20906 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20907 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20908 /* Check for cycle. */
20909 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20910 break;
20914 break;
20916 default:
20917 invalid:
20918 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20919 goto tail_recurse;
20922 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20923 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20925 switch (mode_line_target)
20927 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20928 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20929 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20930 break;
20931 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20932 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20933 break;
20934 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20935 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20936 0, 0, 0);
20937 break;
20941 return n;
20944 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20946 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20947 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20949 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20950 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20951 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20953 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20954 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20956 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20957 properties to the string.
20959 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20960 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20963 static int
20964 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20965 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20967 ptrdiff_t len;
20968 int n = 0;
20970 if (string != NULL)
20972 len = strlen (string);
20973 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20974 len = precision;
20975 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20976 if (NILP (props))
20977 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20978 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20980 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20981 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20982 if (NILP (face))
20983 face = mode_line_string_face;
20984 else
20985 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20986 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20988 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20989 props, lisp_string);
20991 else
20993 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20994 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20996 len = precision;
20997 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20998 precision = -1;
21000 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
21002 Lisp_Object face;
21003 if (NILP (props))
21004 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
21005 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
21006 if (NILP (face))
21007 face = mode_line_string_face;
21008 else
21009 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
21010 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
21011 if (copy_string)
21012 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
21014 if (!NILP (props))
21015 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
21016 props, lisp_string);
21019 if (len > 0)
21021 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21022 n += len;
21025 if (field_width > len)
21027 field_width -= len;
21028 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
21029 if (!NILP (props))
21030 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
21031 props, lisp_string);
21032 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21033 n += field_width;
21036 return n;
21040 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
21041 1, 4, 0,
21042 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
21043 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
21044 for details) to use.
21046 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
21048 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
21049 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
21050 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21051 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21052 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21053 An integer value means the value string has no text
21054 properties.
21056 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21057 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21058 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21059 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21060 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21062 struct it it;
21063 int len;
21064 struct window *w;
21065 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21066 int face_id;
21067 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21068 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21069 Lisp_Object str;
21070 int string_start = 0;
21072 if (NILP (window))
21073 window = selected_window;
21074 CHECK_WINDOW (window);
21075 w = XWINDOW (window);
21077 if (NILP (buffer))
21078 buffer = w->buffer;
21079 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21081 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21082 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21083 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21084 return empty_unibyte_string;
21086 if (no_props)
21087 face = Qnil;
21089 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21090 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21091 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21092 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21093 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21094 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21095 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21096 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21098 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21100 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21101 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21102 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21103 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21104 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))),
21105 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21106 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21108 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21109 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21111 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21113 if (no_props)
21115 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21116 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21117 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21118 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21120 else
21122 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21123 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21124 mode_line_string_face = face;
21125 mode_line_string_face_prop
21126 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
21129 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21130 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21131 pop_kboard ();
21133 if (no_props)
21135 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21136 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21138 else
21140 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21141 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21142 empty_unibyte_string);
21145 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21146 return str;
21149 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21150 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21152 static void
21153 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21155 register char *p = buf;
21157 if (d <= 0)
21158 *p++ = '0';
21159 else
21161 while (d > 0)
21163 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21164 d /= 10;
21168 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21169 *p++ = ' ';
21170 *p-- = '\0';
21171 while (p > buf)
21173 d = *buf;
21174 *buf++ = *p;
21175 *p-- = d;
21179 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21180 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21181 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21183 static const char power_letter[] =
21185 0, /* no letter */
21186 'k', /* kilo */
21187 'M', /* mega */
21188 'G', /* giga */
21189 'T', /* tera */
21190 'P', /* peta */
21191 'E', /* exa */
21192 'Z', /* zetta */
21193 'Y' /* yotta */
21196 static void
21197 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21199 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21200 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21201 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21202 int remainder = 0;
21203 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21204 int tenths = -1;
21205 int exponent = 0;
21207 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21208 int length;
21210 char * psuffix;
21211 char * p;
21213 if (1000 <= quotient)
21215 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21218 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21219 quotient /= 1000;
21220 exponent++;
21222 while (1000 <= quotient);
21224 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21225 if (quotient <= 9)
21227 tenths = remainder / 100;
21228 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
21230 if (tenths < 9)
21231 tenths++;
21232 else
21234 quotient++;
21235 if (quotient == 10)
21236 tenths = -1;
21237 else
21238 tenths = 0;
21242 else
21243 if (500 <= remainder)
21245 if (quotient < 999)
21246 quotient++;
21247 else
21249 quotient = 1;
21250 exponent++;
21251 tenths = 0;
21256 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21257 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21258 if (quotient <= 9)
21259 length = 1;
21260 else
21261 length = 2;
21262 else
21263 length = 3;
21264 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21266 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21267 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21268 *psuffix = '\0';
21270 /* Print TENTHS. */
21271 if (tenths >= 0)
21273 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21274 *--p = '.';
21277 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21280 int digit = quotient % 10;
21281 *--p = '0' + digit;
21283 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21285 /* Print leading spaces. */
21286 while (buf < p)
21287 *--p = ' ';
21290 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21291 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21292 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21294 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21296 static char *
21297 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21299 Lisp_Object val;
21300 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21301 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21302 int eol_str_len;
21303 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21304 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21306 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21307 eoltype = Qnil;
21309 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21311 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21312 if (eol_flag)
21313 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21314 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21316 else
21318 Lisp_Object attrs;
21319 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21321 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21322 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21324 *buf++ = multibyte
21325 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21326 : ' ';
21328 if (eol_flag)
21330 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21332 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21333 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21334 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21335 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21336 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21337 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21338 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21339 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21340 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
21344 if (eol_flag)
21346 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
21347 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
21349 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
21350 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
21352 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
21354 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
21355 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
21356 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
21357 eol_str = tmp;
21359 else
21361 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
21362 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
21364 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
21365 buf += eol_str_len;
21368 return buf;
21371 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
21372 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
21373 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
21374 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
21376 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
21377 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
21379 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
21381 static const char *
21382 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
21383 Lisp_Object *string)
21385 Lisp_Object obj;
21386 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
21387 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
21388 /* We are going to use f->decode_mode_spec_buffer as the buffer to
21389 produce strings from numerical values, so limit preposterously
21390 large values of FIELD_WIDTH to avoid overrunning the buffer's
21391 end. The size of the buffer is enough for FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE
21392 bytes plus the terminating null. */
21393 int width = min (field_width, FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f));
21394 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
21396 obj = Qnil;
21397 *string = Qnil;
21399 switch (c)
21401 case '*':
21402 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21403 return "%";
21404 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21405 return "*";
21406 return "-";
21408 case '+':
21409 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
21410 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21411 return "*";
21412 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21413 return "%";
21414 return "-";
21416 case '&':
21417 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
21418 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21419 return "*";
21420 return "-";
21422 case '%':
21423 return "%";
21425 case '[':
21427 int i;
21428 char *p;
21430 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21431 return "[[[... ";
21432 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21433 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21434 *p++ = '[';
21435 *p = 0;
21436 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21439 case ']':
21441 int i;
21442 char *p;
21444 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21445 return " ...]]]";
21446 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21447 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21448 *p++ = ']';
21449 *p = 0;
21450 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21453 case '-':
21455 register int i;
21457 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
21458 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
21459 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
21460 return "--";
21461 if (field_width <= 0
21462 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
21464 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
21465 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
21466 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
21467 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21469 else
21470 return lots_of_dashes;
21473 case 'b':
21474 obj = BVAR (b, name);
21475 break;
21477 case 'c':
21478 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
21479 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
21480 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
21481 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
21482 even crash emacs.) */
21483 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21484 return "";
21485 else
21487 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
21488 wset_column_number_displayed (w, make_number (col));
21489 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, col);
21490 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21493 case 'e':
21494 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
21496 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
21497 return "";
21498 else
21499 return "!MEM FULL! ";
21501 #else
21502 return "";
21503 #endif
21505 case 'F':
21506 /* %F displays the frame name. */
21507 if (!NILP (f->title))
21508 return SSDATA (f->title);
21509 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21510 return SSDATA (f->name);
21511 return "Emacs";
21513 case 'f':
21514 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
21515 break;
21517 case 'i':
21519 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21520 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21521 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21524 case 'I':
21526 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21527 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21528 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21531 case 'l':
21533 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
21534 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
21535 ptrdiff_t junk;
21537 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
21538 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21539 return "";
21541 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
21542 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
21543 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
21545 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
21546 don't forget that too fast. */
21547 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
21548 goto no_value;
21549 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
21550 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
21551 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21553 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
21554 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
21555 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
21557 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21558 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21559 goto no_value;
21562 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
21563 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
21564 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
21566 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
21567 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
21568 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
21570 else
21572 line = 1;
21573 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
21574 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21577 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
21578 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
21579 startpos_byte,
21580 startpos, &junk);
21582 topline = nlines + line;
21584 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
21585 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
21586 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
21587 go back past it. */
21588 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21590 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline));
21591 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BUF_BEGV (b)));
21593 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
21594 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21596 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
21597 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21598 ptrdiff_t position;
21599 ptrdiff_t distance =
21600 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
21602 if (startpos - distance > limit)
21604 limit = startpos - distance;
21605 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
21608 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21609 limit_byte,
21610 - (height * 2 + 30),
21611 &position);
21612 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
21613 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
21614 give up on line numbers for this window. */
21615 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
21617 wset_base_line_pos (w, w->buffer);
21618 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21619 goto no_value;
21622 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline - nlines));
21623 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position)));
21626 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
21627 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21628 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
21630 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
21631 line_number_displayed = 1;
21633 /* Make the string to show. */
21634 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, topline + nlines);
21635 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21636 no_value:
21638 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21639 int pad = width - 2;
21640 while (pad-- > 0)
21641 *p++ = ' ';
21642 *p++ = '?';
21643 *p++ = '?';
21644 *p = '\0';
21645 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21648 break;
21650 case 'm':
21651 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21652 break;
21654 case 'n':
21655 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21656 return " Narrow";
21657 break;
21659 case 'p':
21661 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
21662 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21664 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21666 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21667 return "All";
21668 else
21669 return "Bottom";
21671 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21672 return "Top";
21673 else
21675 if (total > 1000000)
21676 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21677 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21678 else
21679 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21680 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21681 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21682 if (total == 100)
21683 total = 99;
21684 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21685 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21689 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21690 case 'P':
21692 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21693 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21694 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21696 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21698 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21699 return "All";
21700 else
21701 return "Bottom";
21703 else
21705 if (total > 1000000)
21706 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21707 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21708 else
21709 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21710 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21711 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21712 if (total == 100)
21713 total = 99;
21714 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21715 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
21716 else
21717 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21718 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21722 case 's':
21723 /* status of process */
21724 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21725 if (NILP (obj))
21726 return "no process";
21727 #ifndef MSDOS
21728 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21729 #endif
21730 break;
21732 case '@':
21734 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21735 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21736 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21737 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21739 if (NILP (val))
21740 return "-";
21741 else
21742 return "@";
21745 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21746 return "T";
21748 case 'z':
21749 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21750 case 'Z':
21751 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21753 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21754 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21756 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21758 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21759 to do EOL conversion. */
21760 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21761 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21762 p, 0);
21763 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21764 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21765 p, 0);
21767 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21768 p, eol_flag);
21770 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21771 #ifdef subprocesses
21772 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21773 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21775 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21776 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21777 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21778 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21780 #endif /* subprocesses */
21781 #endif /* 0 */
21782 *p = 0;
21783 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21787 if (STRINGP (obj))
21789 *string = obj;
21790 return SSDATA (obj);
21792 else
21793 return "";
21797 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21798 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21799 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21801 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21803 static ptrdiff_t
21804 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
21805 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
21806 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
21808 register unsigned char *cursor;
21809 unsigned char *base;
21811 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
21812 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21813 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
21815 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21816 check only for newlines. */
21817 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21818 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21820 if (count > 0)
21822 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21824 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21825 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21826 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21827 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21828 while (1)
21830 if (selective_display)
21831 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21833 else
21834 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21837 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21839 if (--count == 0)
21841 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21842 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21843 return orig_count;
21845 else
21846 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21847 break;
21849 else
21850 break;
21852 start_byte += cursor - base;
21855 else
21857 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21859 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21860 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21861 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21862 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21863 while (1)
21865 if (selective_display)
21866 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21867 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21869 else
21870 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21873 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21875 if (++count == 0)
21877 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21878 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21879 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21880 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21881 return - orig_count - 1;
21884 else
21885 break;
21887 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21888 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21889 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21893 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21895 if (count < 0)
21896 return - orig_count + count;
21897 return orig_count - count;
21903 /***********************************************************************
21904 Displaying strings
21905 ***********************************************************************/
21907 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21909 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21910 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21911 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21912 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21913 ignoring its text properties.
21915 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21916 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21917 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21919 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21920 standard display table, temporarily.
21922 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21923 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21924 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21925 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21927 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21928 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21930 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21932 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21933 ----------------------------------------
21934 -1 -1 %s
21935 -1 10 %.10s
21936 10 -1 %10s
21937 20 10 %20.10s
21939 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21940 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21941 enable_multibyte_characters.
21943 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21945 static int
21946 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21947 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
21948 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21950 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21951 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21952 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21953 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
21955 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21956 with index START. */
21957 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21958 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21959 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21960 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21961 ignore its text properties. */
21962 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21964 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21965 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21966 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21968 ptrdiff_t endptr;
21969 struct face *face;
21971 it->face_id
21972 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21973 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21974 it->region_end_charpos,
21975 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21976 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21977 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21980 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21981 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21982 if (max_x <= 0)
21983 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21984 else
21985 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21987 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21988 hscrolled. */
21989 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21990 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21991 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21993 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21994 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21995 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21996 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21997 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21999 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22000 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22001 else
22002 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22004 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
22005 past last_visible_x. */
22006 while (it->current_x < max_x)
22008 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
22010 /* Get the next display element. */
22011 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
22012 break;
22014 /* Produce glyphs. */
22015 x_before = it->current_x;
22016 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
22017 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
22019 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
22020 i = 0;
22021 x = x_before;
22022 while (i < nglyphs)
22024 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
22026 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
22027 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
22029 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
22030 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
22032 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
22033 if (row->reversed_p)
22034 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22035 - n_glyphs_before);
22036 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
22037 it->current_x = x_before;
22039 else
22041 if (row->reversed_p)
22042 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22043 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
22044 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
22045 it->current_x = x;
22047 break;
22049 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
22051 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
22052 ++it->hpos;
22053 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
22054 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22056 else
22058 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22059 Should not happen. */
22060 emacs_abort ();
22063 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22064 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22065 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22066 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22067 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22068 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22069 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22070 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22071 ++i;
22074 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22075 if (i < nglyphs)
22076 break;
22078 /* Stop at line ends. */
22079 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22081 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22082 break;
22085 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22086 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22087 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22088 else
22089 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22091 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22092 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22093 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22095 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22096 truncated at a padding space. */
22097 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22099 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22101 int ii, n;
22103 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22105 if (!row->reversed_p)
22107 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22108 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22109 break;
22111 else
22113 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22114 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22115 break;
22116 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22117 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22119 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22121 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22122 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22125 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22127 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22129 break;
22133 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22134 if (it->first_visible_x
22135 && it_charpos > 0)
22137 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22138 || (row->reversed_p
22139 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22140 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22141 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22142 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22145 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22147 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22148 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22153 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22154 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22155 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22156 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22157 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22158 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22159 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22162 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22164 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22166 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22168 register Lisp_Object tem;
22169 tem = XCAR (tail);
22170 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22171 return 1;
22172 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22173 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22176 if (CONSP (propval))
22178 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22180 Lisp_Object propelt;
22181 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22182 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22184 register Lisp_Object tem;
22185 tem = XCAR (tail);
22186 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22187 return 1;
22188 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22189 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22194 return 0;
22197 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22198 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22199 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22200 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22201 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22202 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22203 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22204 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22205 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22207 Lisp_Object prop
22208 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22209 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22210 : pos_or_prop);
22211 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22212 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22213 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22214 : make_number (invis));
22217 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22218 the following elements:
22220 SPEC ::=
22221 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22222 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22223 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22224 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22225 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22226 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22227 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22228 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22230 NUM ::=
22231 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22232 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22234 UNIT ::=
22235 in - pixels per inch *)
22236 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22237 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22238 width - width of current font in pixels.
22239 height - height of current font in pixels.
22241 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22243 ELEMENT ::=
22245 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22246 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22248 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22249 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22251 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22253 Examples:
22255 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22256 (5 . in)
22258 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22259 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22261 Align to first text column (in header line):
22262 '(space :align-to 0)
22264 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22265 containing a loaded image:
22266 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22268 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22269 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22271 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22272 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22274 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22275 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22277 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22278 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22279 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22280 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22284 #define NUMVAL(X) \
22285 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
22286 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
22287 : - 1)
22289 static int
22290 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22291 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22293 double pixels;
22295 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22296 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22298 if (NILP (prop))
22299 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22301 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22303 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22305 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22307 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22309 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22310 pixels = 1.0;
22311 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22312 pixels = 25.4;
22313 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22314 pixels = 2.54;
22315 else
22316 pixels = 0;
22317 if (pixels > 0)
22319 double ppi;
22320 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22321 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22322 && (ppi = (width_p
22323 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
22324 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
22325 ppi > 0))
22326 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22327 #endif
22329 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
22330 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
22331 && (ppi = (width_p
22332 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
22333 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
22334 ppi > 0)))
22335 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22337 return 0;
22341 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22342 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22343 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22344 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22345 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22346 #else
22347 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22348 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22349 #endif
22351 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22352 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22353 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22354 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22356 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22358 *res = 0;
22359 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22360 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22361 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
22362 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22363 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
22364 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22365 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
22366 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22367 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22368 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
22369 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22370 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22371 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22372 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22373 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22374 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22375 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22376 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22377 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
22378 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22379 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
22381 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22382 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22383 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22384 : 0)));
22386 else
22388 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22389 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22390 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22391 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22392 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22393 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22394 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22395 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22396 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22397 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
22400 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->buffer);
22401 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
22402 prop = Qnil;
22405 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
22407 int base_unit = (width_p
22408 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
22409 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22410 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
22413 if (CONSP (prop))
22415 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
22416 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
22418 if (SYMBOLP (car))
22420 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22421 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22422 && valid_image_p (prop))
22424 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
22425 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
22427 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
22429 #endif
22430 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
22432 int first = 1;
22433 double px;
22435 pixels = 0;
22436 while (CONSP (cdr))
22438 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
22439 font, width_p, align_to))
22440 return 0;
22441 if (first)
22442 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
22443 else
22444 pixels += px;
22445 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
22447 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
22448 pixels = -pixels;
22449 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22452 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->buffer);
22453 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
22454 car = Qnil;
22457 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
22459 double fact;
22460 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
22461 if (NILP (cdr))
22462 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22463 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
22464 font, width_p, align_to))
22465 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
22466 return 0;
22469 return 0;
22472 return 0;
22476 /***********************************************************************
22477 Glyph Display
22478 ***********************************************************************/
22480 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22482 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
22484 void
22485 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22487 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
22488 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
22489 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
22490 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
22491 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
22492 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
22493 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
22494 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
22495 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
22496 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
22497 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
22498 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
22501 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
22503 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
22504 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
22505 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
22506 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
22507 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
22508 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
22509 face-override for drawing S. */
22511 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22512 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
22513 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
22514 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
22515 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
22516 #endif
22518 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
22519 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
22520 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
22521 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
22522 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
22523 #endif
22525 static void
22526 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
22527 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
22528 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
22529 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
22531 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
22532 s->w = w;
22533 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
22534 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22535 s->hdc = hdc;
22536 #endif
22537 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
22538 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
22539 s->char2b = char2b;
22540 s->hl = hl;
22541 s->row = row;
22542 s->area = area;
22543 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
22544 s->height = row->height;
22545 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
22546 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
22550 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
22551 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
22553 static void
22554 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22555 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22557 if (h)
22559 if (*head)
22560 (*tail)->next = h;
22561 else
22562 *head = h;
22563 h->prev = *tail;
22564 *tail = t;
22569 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
22570 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
22571 result. */
22573 static void
22574 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22575 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22577 if (h)
22579 if (*head)
22580 (*head)->prev = t;
22581 else
22582 *tail = t;
22583 t->next = *head;
22584 *head = h;
22589 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
22590 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
22592 static void
22593 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22594 struct glyph_string *s)
22596 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
22597 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
22601 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
22602 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
22603 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
22604 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
22605 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
22607 static struct face *
22608 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
22609 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
22611 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
22613 if (face->font)
22615 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
22617 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22618 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22619 else
22620 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22623 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22624 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
22625 if (display_p)
22626 #endif
22628 eassert (face != NULL);
22629 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22632 return face;
22636 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
22637 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
22638 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
22640 static struct face *
22641 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
22642 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
22644 struct face *face;
22646 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
22647 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
22649 if (two_byte_p)
22650 *two_byte_p = 0;
22652 if (face->font)
22654 unsigned code;
22656 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22657 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22658 else
22659 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22661 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22662 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22663 else
22664 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22667 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22668 eassert (face != NULL);
22669 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22670 return face;
22674 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22675 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22677 static int
22678 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22680 unsigned code;
22682 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22683 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22684 else
22685 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22687 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22688 return 0;
22689 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22690 return 1;
22694 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22696 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22697 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22699 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22700 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22702 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22704 static int
22705 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22706 int overlaps)
22708 int i;
22709 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22710 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22711 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22712 struct face *face;
22714 eassert (s);
22716 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22717 s->face = NULL;
22718 s->font = NULL;
22719 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22721 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22723 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22724 on the left or right. */
22725 if (c != '\t')
22727 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22728 -1, Qnil);
22730 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22731 s->char2b + i, 1);
22732 if (face)
22734 if (! s->face)
22736 s->face = face;
22737 s->font = s->face->font;
22739 else if (s->face != face)
22740 break;
22743 ++s->nchars;
22745 s->cmp_to = i;
22747 if (s->face == NULL)
22749 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
22750 s->font = s->face->font;
22753 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22754 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22755 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22757 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22758 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22759 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22760 characters of the glyph string. */
22761 if (s->font == NULL)
22763 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22764 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22767 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22768 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22770 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22771 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22773 return s->cmp_to;
22776 static int
22777 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22778 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22780 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22781 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22782 int i;
22784 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22785 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22786 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22787 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22788 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22789 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22790 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22791 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22792 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22793 glyph++;
22794 while (glyph < last
22795 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22796 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22797 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22798 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22800 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22802 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22803 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22805 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22807 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22808 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22812 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22813 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22814 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22817 static int
22818 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22819 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22821 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22822 int voffset;
22824 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22825 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22826 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22827 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22828 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22829 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22830 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22831 s->nchars = 1;
22832 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22833 glyph++;
22834 while (glyph < last
22835 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22836 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22837 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22839 s->nchars++;
22840 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22841 glyph++;
22843 s->ybase += voffset;
22844 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22848 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22850 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22851 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22852 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22853 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22855 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22857 static int
22858 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22859 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22861 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22862 int voffset;
22863 int glyph_not_available_p;
22865 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22866 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
22867 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22869 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22870 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22871 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22872 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22873 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22874 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22876 while (glyph < last
22877 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22878 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22879 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22880 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22881 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22883 int two_byte_p;
22885 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22886 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22887 &two_byte_p);
22888 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22889 ++s->nchars;
22890 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22891 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22892 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22893 break;
22896 s->font = s->face->font;
22898 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22899 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22900 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22901 characters of the glyph string. */
22902 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22904 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22905 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22908 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22909 s->ybase += voffset;
22911 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22912 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22916 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22918 static void
22919 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22921 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22922 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22923 eassert (s->img);
22924 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22925 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22926 s->font = s->face->font;
22927 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22929 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22930 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22934 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22936 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22937 END is the index of the last + 1.
22939 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22941 static int
22942 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22944 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22945 int voffset, face_id;
22947 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22949 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22950 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22951 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22952 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22953 s->font = s->face->font;
22954 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22955 s->nchars = 1;
22956 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22958 for (++glyph;
22959 (glyph < last
22960 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22961 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22962 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22963 ++glyph)
22964 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22966 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22967 s->ybase += voffset;
22969 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22970 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22971 eassert (s->face);
22972 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22975 static struct font_metrics *
22976 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22978 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22979 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22981 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22982 return NULL;
22983 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22984 return &metrics;
22987 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22988 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22989 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22990 assumed to be zero. */
22992 void
22993 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22995 *left = *right = 0;
22997 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22999 struct face *face;
23000 XChar2b char2b;
23001 struct font_metrics *pcm;
23003 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
23004 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
23006 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
23007 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
23008 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
23009 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
23012 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
23014 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
23016 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
23018 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
23019 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
23020 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
23021 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
23023 else
23025 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
23026 struct font_metrics metrics;
23028 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
23029 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
23030 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
23031 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
23032 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
23033 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
23039 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23040 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
23041 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
23043 static int
23044 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23046 int k;
23048 if (s->left_overhang)
23050 int x = 0, i;
23051 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23052 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23054 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23055 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23057 k = i + 1;
23059 else
23060 k = -1;
23062 return k;
23066 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23067 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23068 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23070 static int
23071 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23073 int i, k, x;
23074 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23075 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23077 k = -1;
23078 x = 0;
23079 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23081 int left, right;
23082 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23083 if (x + right > 0)
23084 k = i;
23085 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23088 return k;
23092 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23093 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23094 no such glyph is found. */
23096 static int
23097 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23099 int k = -1;
23101 if (s->right_overhang)
23103 int x = 0, i;
23104 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23105 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23106 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23107 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23109 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23110 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23112 k = i;
23115 return k;
23119 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23120 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23121 if no such glyph is found. */
23123 static int
23124 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23126 int i, k, x;
23127 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23128 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23129 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23130 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23132 k = -1;
23133 x = 0;
23134 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23136 int left, right;
23137 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23138 if (x - left < 0)
23139 k = i;
23140 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23143 return k;
23147 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23148 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23149 in the drawing area. */
23151 static void
23152 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23154 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23155 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23157 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23158 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23159 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23160 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23161 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23162 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23163 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23164 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23166 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23167 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23168 area. */
23169 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23170 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23171 else
23172 s->background_width = s->width;
23176 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23177 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23178 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23180 static void
23181 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23183 if (backward_p)
23185 while (s)
23187 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23188 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23189 x -= s->width;
23190 s->x = x;
23191 s = s->prev;
23194 else
23196 while (s)
23198 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23199 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23200 s->x = x;
23201 x += s->width;
23202 s = s->next;
23209 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23210 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23211 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23212 as well as the following local variables:
23213 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23215 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23216 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23217 init_glyph_string. */
23218 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23219 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23220 #else
23221 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23222 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23223 #endif
23225 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23226 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23227 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23228 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23229 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23230 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23231 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23233 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23234 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23235 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23236 do \
23238 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23239 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23240 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23241 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23242 s->x = (X); \
23244 while (0)
23247 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23248 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23249 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23250 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23251 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23252 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23253 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23255 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23256 do \
23258 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23259 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23260 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23261 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23262 ++START; \
23263 s->x = (X); \
23265 while (0)
23268 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23269 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23270 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23271 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23272 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23273 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23274 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23275 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23277 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23278 do \
23280 int face_id; \
23281 XChar2b *char2b; \
23283 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23285 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23286 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23287 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23288 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23289 s->x = (X); \
23290 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23292 while (0)
23295 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23296 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23297 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23298 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23299 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23300 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23301 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23302 x-position of the drawing area. */
23304 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23305 do { \
23306 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23307 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23308 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23309 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23310 XChar2b *char2b; \
23311 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23312 int n; \
23314 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23316 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23317 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23318 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23320 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23321 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23322 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23323 s->cmp = cmp; \
23324 s->cmp_from = n; \
23325 s->x = (X); \
23326 if (n == 0) \
23327 first_s = s; \
23328 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23331 ++START; \
23332 s = first_s; \
23333 } while (0)
23336 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23337 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23339 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23340 do { \
23341 int face_id; \
23342 XChar2b *char2b; \
23343 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23345 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23346 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23347 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23348 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23349 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23350 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23351 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23352 s->x = (X); \
23353 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23354 } while (0)
23357 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23358 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
23359 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
23361 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23362 do \
23364 int face_id; \
23366 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23368 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23369 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23370 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23371 s->x = (X); \
23372 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
23373 overlaps); \
23375 while (0)
23378 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
23379 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
23380 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
23381 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
23382 x-positions of the drawing area.
23384 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
23385 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
23386 asynchronously). */
23388 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23389 do \
23391 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
23392 while (START < END) \
23394 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
23395 switch (first_glyph->type) \
23397 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
23398 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23399 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23400 break; \
23402 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
23403 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
23404 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23405 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23406 else \
23407 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23408 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23409 break; \
23411 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
23412 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23413 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23414 break; \
23416 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
23417 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23418 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23419 break; \
23421 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
23422 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23423 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23424 break; \
23426 default: \
23427 emacs_abort (); \
23430 if (s) \
23432 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
23433 (X) += s->width; \
23436 } while (0)
23439 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
23440 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
23441 face-override with the following meaning:
23443 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
23444 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
23445 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
23446 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
23447 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
23448 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
23450 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
23451 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
23452 the overlapping part to be drawn:
23454 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
23455 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
23456 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
23457 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
23459 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
23461 static int
23462 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
23463 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
23464 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
23466 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
23467 struct glyph_string *s;
23468 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
23469 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
23470 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
23471 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
23473 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
23475 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
23476 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
23477 start = max (0, start);
23478 start = min (end, start);
23480 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
23481 end of the drawing area. */
23482 if (row->full_width_p)
23484 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
23485 or fringes. */
23486 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
23487 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
23489 else
23491 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
23492 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
23494 x += area_left;
23496 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
23497 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
23498 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
23499 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
23500 i = start;
23501 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
23502 if (tail)
23503 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
23504 else
23505 x_reached = x;
23507 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
23508 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
23509 strings built above. */
23510 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
23512 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
23513 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
23514 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
23515 int check_mouse_face = 0;
23516 int dummy_x = 0;
23518 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
23519 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
23520 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p
23521 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row >= 0
23522 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= 0)
23524 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
23526 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
23527 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
23529 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
23531 check_mouse_face = 1;
23532 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
23533 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
23534 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
23535 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
23536 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
23540 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
23541 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23542 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23543 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23545 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23546 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
23547 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
23548 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
23549 draws over it. */
23550 i = left_overwritten (head);
23551 if (i >= 0)
23553 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23555 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
23556 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
23557 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
23558 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
23559 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
23560 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
23561 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
23562 if (check_mouse_face
23563 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23564 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23565 else
23566 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23568 j = i;
23569 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
23570 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23571 start = i;
23572 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23573 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23574 clip_head = head;
23577 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23578 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
23579 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
23580 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
23581 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
23582 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
23583 strings exist. */
23584 i = left_overwriting (head);
23585 if (i >= 0)
23587 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23589 if (check_mouse_face
23590 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23591 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23592 else
23593 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23595 clip_head = head;
23596 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
23597 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23598 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23599 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23600 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23601 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23604 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23605 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
23606 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
23607 over it. */
23608 i = right_overwritten (tail);
23609 if (i >= 0)
23611 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23613 if (check_mouse_face
23614 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23615 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23616 else
23617 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23619 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23620 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23621 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
23622 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
23623 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23624 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23625 clip_tail = tail;
23628 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23629 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
23630 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
23631 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
23632 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
23633 i = right_overwriting (tail);
23634 if (i >= 0)
23636 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23637 if (check_mouse_face
23638 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23639 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23640 else
23641 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23643 clip_tail = tail;
23644 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
23645 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23646 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23647 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23649 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23650 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23652 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
23653 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23655 s->clip_head = clip_head;
23656 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
23660 /* Draw all strings. */
23661 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23662 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23664 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23665 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23666 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23667 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23668 && !row->full_width_p
23669 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23670 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23671 completely. */
23672 && !overlaps)
23674 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23675 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23676 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23677 x0 -= area_left;
23678 x1 -= area_left;
23680 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23681 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23683 #endif
23685 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23686 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23687 if (row->full_width_p)
23688 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23689 else
23690 x_reached -= area_left;
23692 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23694 return x_reached;
23697 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23698 is not present. */
23700 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23702 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23703 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23704 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23706 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23707 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23711 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23712 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23714 static void
23715 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23717 struct glyph *glyph;
23718 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23720 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23721 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23723 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23724 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23726 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23727 rather than append it. */
23728 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23730 struct glyph *g;
23732 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23733 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23734 g[1] = *g;
23735 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23737 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23738 glyph->object = it->object;
23739 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23741 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23742 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23744 else
23746 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23747 be displayed correctly. */
23748 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23749 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23751 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23752 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23753 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23754 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23755 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23756 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23757 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23758 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23759 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23760 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23761 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23762 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23763 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23764 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23765 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23766 if (it->bidi_p)
23768 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23769 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23770 emacs_abort ();
23771 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23773 else
23775 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23776 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23778 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23780 else
23781 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23784 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23785 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23786 non-null. */
23788 static void
23789 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23791 struct glyph *glyph;
23792 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23794 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23796 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23797 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23799 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23800 rather than append it. */
23801 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23803 struct glyph *g;
23805 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23806 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23807 g[1] = *g;
23808 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23810 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23811 glyph->object = it->object;
23812 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23813 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23814 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23815 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23816 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23817 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23819 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23820 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23821 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23823 else
23825 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23826 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23827 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23828 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23830 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23831 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23832 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23833 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23834 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23835 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23836 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23837 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23838 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23839 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23840 if (it->bidi_p)
23842 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23843 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23844 emacs_abort ();
23845 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23847 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23849 else
23850 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23854 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23855 IT->voffset. */
23857 static void
23858 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23860 if (it->voffset)
23862 if (it->voffset < 0)
23863 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23864 in the line. */
23865 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23866 else
23867 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23868 in the line. */
23869 it->descent += it->voffset;
23874 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23875 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23876 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23878 static void
23879 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23881 struct image *img;
23882 struct face *face;
23883 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23884 struct glyph_slice slice;
23886 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23888 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23889 eassert (face);
23890 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23891 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23893 if (it->image_id < 0)
23895 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23896 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23897 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23898 it->pixel_width = 0;
23899 it->nglyphs = 0;
23900 return;
23903 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23904 eassert (img);
23905 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23906 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23908 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23909 slice.width = img->width;
23910 slice.height = img->height;
23912 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23913 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23914 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23915 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23917 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23918 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23919 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23920 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23922 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23923 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23924 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23925 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23927 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23928 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23929 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23930 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23932 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23933 slice.x = img->width;
23934 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23935 slice.y = img->height;
23936 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23937 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23938 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23939 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23941 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23942 return;
23944 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23946 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23947 if (slice.y == 0)
23948 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23949 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23950 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23951 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23953 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23954 if (slice.x == 0)
23955 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23956 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23957 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23959 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23960 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23961 if (it->descent < 0)
23962 it->descent = 0;
23964 it->nglyphs = 1;
23966 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23968 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23970 if (slice.y == 0)
23971 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23972 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23973 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23976 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23977 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23978 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23979 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23982 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23984 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23985 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23986 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23987 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23989 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23990 slice.width -= crop;
23993 if (it->glyph_row)
23995 struct glyph *glyph;
23996 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23998 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23999 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24001 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24002 glyph->object = it->object;
24003 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24004 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
24005 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24006 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24007 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
24008 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24009 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24010 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24011 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24012 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24013 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24014 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24015 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24016 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
24017 glyph->slice.img = slice;
24018 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24019 if (it->bidi_p)
24021 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24022 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24023 emacs_abort ();
24024 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24026 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24028 else
24029 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24034 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
24035 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
24036 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
24038 static void
24039 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
24040 int width, int height, int ascent)
24042 struct glyph *glyph;
24043 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24045 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
24047 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24048 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24050 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24051 rather than append it. */
24052 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24054 struct glyph *g;
24056 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24057 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24058 g[1] = *g;
24059 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24061 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24062 glyph->object = object;
24063 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24064 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24065 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24066 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24067 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24068 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24069 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24070 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24071 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24072 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24073 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24074 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24075 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24076 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24077 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24078 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24079 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24080 if (it->bidi_p)
24082 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24083 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24084 emacs_abort ();
24085 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24087 else
24089 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24090 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24092 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24094 else
24095 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24098 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24100 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24101 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24102 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24103 being recognized:
24105 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24106 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24107 point number.
24109 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24110 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24111 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24113 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24114 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24116 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24118 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24119 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24121 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24122 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24123 the glyph property.
24125 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24127 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24128 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24129 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24131 void
24132 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24134 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24135 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24136 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24137 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24138 double tem;
24139 struct font *font = NULL;
24141 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24142 int ascent = 0;
24143 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24145 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24147 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24148 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24149 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24151 #endif
24153 /* List should start with `space'. */
24154 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24155 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24157 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24158 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24159 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24161 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24162 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24163 width = (int)tem;
24165 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24166 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24167 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24169 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24170 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24171 property. */
24172 struct it it2;
24173 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24175 it2 = *it;
24176 if (it->multibyte_p)
24177 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24178 else
24180 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24181 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24182 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24185 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24186 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24187 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24188 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24190 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24191 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24192 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24194 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24195 align_to = (align_to < 0
24197 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24198 else if (align_to < 0)
24199 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24200 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24201 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24203 else
24204 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24205 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24207 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24208 width = 1;
24210 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24211 /* Compute height. */
24212 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24214 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24215 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24217 height = (int)tem;
24218 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24220 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24221 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24222 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24223 else
24224 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24226 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24227 height = 1;
24229 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24230 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24231 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24232 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24233 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24234 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24235 else if (!NILP (prop)
24236 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24237 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24238 else
24239 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24241 else
24242 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24243 height = 1;
24245 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24246 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24248 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24249 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24250 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24251 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24252 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24253 #endif
24256 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24258 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24259 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24260 int n = width;
24262 if (!STRINGP (object))
24263 object = it->w->buffer;
24264 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24265 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24266 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24267 else
24268 #endif
24270 it->object = object;
24271 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24272 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24273 while (n--)
24274 tty_append_glyph (it);
24275 it->object = o_object;
24279 it->pixel_width = width;
24280 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24281 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24283 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24284 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24285 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24286 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24288 else
24289 #endif
24290 it->nglyphs = width;
24293 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24294 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24295 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24296 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24297 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24299 static void
24300 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24302 struct it temp_it;
24303 Lisp_Object gc;
24304 GLYPH glyph;
24306 temp_it = *it;
24307 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24308 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24310 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24312 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24313 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24314 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24315 else
24316 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24317 if (it->dp
24318 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24320 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24321 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24322 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24325 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
24327 /* Truncation glyph. */
24328 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
24329 if (it->dp
24330 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24332 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24333 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24334 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24337 else
24338 emacs_abort ();
24340 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24341 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
24342 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
24343 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
24344 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
24345 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
24346 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
24347 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
24348 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
24349 glyphs. */
24350 && temp_it.glyph_row
24351 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
24352 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
24353 width. */
24354 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
24355 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
24356 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
24357 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
24359 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
24361 if (stretch_width > 0)
24363 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
24364 struct font *font =
24365 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
24366 int stretch_ascent =
24367 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
24368 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24370 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
24371 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
24372 stretch_ascent);
24375 #endif
24377 temp_it.dp = NULL;
24378 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24379 temp_it.len = 1;
24380 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
24381 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
24382 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
24384 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
24385 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
24386 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
24389 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24391 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
24392 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
24393 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
24394 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
24395 height of specified face font.
24397 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
24400 static Lisp_Object
24401 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
24402 int boff, int override)
24404 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
24405 int ascent, descent, height;
24407 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
24408 return val;
24410 if (CONSP (val))
24412 face_name = XCAR (val);
24413 val = XCDR (val);
24414 if (!NUMBERP (val))
24415 val = make_number (1);
24416 if (NILP (face_name))
24418 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24419 goto scale;
24423 if (NILP (face_name))
24425 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24426 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
24428 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
24430 override = 0;
24432 else
24434 int face_id;
24435 struct face *face;
24437 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
24438 if (face_id < 0)
24439 return make_number (-1);
24441 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24442 font = face->font;
24443 if (font == NULL)
24444 return make_number (-1);
24445 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24446 if (font->vertical_centering)
24447 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24450 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24451 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24453 if (override)
24455 it->override_ascent = ascent;
24456 it->override_descent = descent;
24457 it->override_boff = boff;
24460 height = ascent + descent;
24462 scale:
24463 if (FLOATP (val))
24464 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
24465 else if (INTEGERP (val))
24466 height *= XINT (val);
24468 return make_number (height);
24472 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
24473 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
24474 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
24476 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
24477 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
24478 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
24479 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
24480 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
24482 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
24484 static void
24485 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
24486 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
24487 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
24489 struct glyph *glyph;
24490 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24492 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24493 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24495 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24496 rather than append it. */
24497 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24499 struct glyph *g;
24501 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24502 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24503 g[1] = *g;
24504 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24506 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24507 glyph->object = it->object;
24508 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24509 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24510 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24511 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24512 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
24513 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
24514 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
24515 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
24516 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
24517 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
24518 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
24519 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
24520 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
24521 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24522 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24523 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24524 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24525 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24526 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24527 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24528 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24529 glyph->face_id = face_id;
24530 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24531 if (it->bidi_p)
24533 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24534 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24535 emacs_abort ();
24536 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24538 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24540 else
24541 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24545 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
24546 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
24547 the character. See the description of enum
24548 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
24550 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
24551 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
24552 for the character. */
24554 static void
24555 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
24557 int face_id;
24558 struct face *face;
24559 struct font *font;
24560 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
24561 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
24562 int len;
24564 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
24565 ASCII face. */
24566 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
24567 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24568 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
24569 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
24570 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24571 base_width = font->average_width;
24573 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
24574 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
24575 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
24576 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
24578 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
24580 else
24582 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
24583 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
24584 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
24585 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
24586 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
24589 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
24591 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
24592 len = 0;
24593 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24595 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
24597 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
24598 if (width == 0)
24599 width = 1;
24600 else if (width > 4)
24601 width = 4;
24602 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
24603 len = 0;
24604 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24606 else
24608 char buf[7];
24609 const char *str;
24610 unsigned int code[6];
24611 int upper_len;
24612 int ascent, descent;
24613 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
24615 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24616 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24617 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24619 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
24621 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
24622 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
24623 if (CONSP (acronym))
24624 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
24625 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
24627 else
24629 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
24630 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
24631 str = buf;
24633 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
24634 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
24635 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
24636 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
24637 &metrics_upper);
24638 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
24639 &metrics_lower);
24643 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
24644 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
24645 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
24646 if (base_width >= width)
24648 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
24649 it->pixel_width = base_width;
24650 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
24652 else
24654 /* Center the shorter one. */
24655 it->pixel_width = width;
24656 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
24657 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
24658 else
24660 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
24661 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
24662 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
24663 lower_xoff = 0;
24664 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
24668 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
24669 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
24670 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
24671 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
24672 /* Center vertically.
24673 H:base_height, D:base_descent
24674 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
24676 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
24677 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
24678 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
24679 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
24680 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
24681 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
24682 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
24683 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
24684 - metrics_upper.descent);
24685 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
24686 if (height > base_height)
24688 it->ascent = ascent;
24689 it->descent = descent;
24693 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24694 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24695 if (it->glyph_row)
24696 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
24697 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
24698 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
24699 it->nglyphs = 1;
24700 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24704 /* RIF:
24705 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
24706 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
24707 for an overview of struct it. */
24709 void
24710 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
24712 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
24714 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24716 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
24718 XChar2b char2b;
24719 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24720 struct font *font = face->font;
24721 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
24722 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24724 if (font == NULL)
24726 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
24727 the method specified in the first extra slot of
24728 Vglyphless_char_display. */
24729 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
24731 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
24732 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
24733 goto done;
24736 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24737 if (font->vertical_centering)
24738 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24740 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
24742 int stretched_p;
24744 it->nglyphs = 1;
24746 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24748 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24749 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24750 boff = it->override_boff;
24752 else
24754 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24755 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24758 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24760 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24761 if (pcm->width == 0
24762 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24763 pcm = NULL;
24766 if (pcm)
24768 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24769 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24770 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24772 else
24774 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24775 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24776 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24777 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24780 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24782 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24784 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24785 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24787 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24789 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24790 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24792 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24793 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24794 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24797 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24798 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24799 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24800 if (stretched_p)
24801 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24803 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24804 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24805 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24806 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24808 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24810 if (thick > 0)
24812 it->ascent += thick;
24813 it->descent += thick;
24815 else
24816 thick = -thick;
24818 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24819 it->pixel_width += thick;
24820 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24821 it->pixel_width += thick;
24824 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24825 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24826 if (face->overline_p)
24827 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24829 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24831 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24832 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24833 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24834 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24837 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24839 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24840 if (it->glyph_row)
24842 if (stretched_p)
24844 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24845 into a stretch glyph. */
24846 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24847 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24848 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24849 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24851 else
24852 append_glyph (it);
24854 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24855 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24856 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24857 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24858 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24860 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24861 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24862 width. */
24863 it->pixel_width = 1;
24865 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24867 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24868 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24869 don't increase that height */
24871 Lisp_Object height;
24872 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24874 it->override_ascent = -1;
24875 it->pixel_width = 0;
24876 it->nglyphs = 0;
24878 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24879 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24880 if (CONSP (height)
24881 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24882 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24884 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24885 height = XCAR (height);
24887 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24889 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24891 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24892 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24893 boff = it->override_boff;
24895 else
24897 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24898 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24901 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24903 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24905 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24906 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24908 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24910 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24911 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24913 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24914 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24915 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24916 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24918 else
24920 Lisp_Object spacing;
24922 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24923 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24925 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24926 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24927 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24929 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24930 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24932 if (!NILP (height)
24933 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24934 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24936 if (!NILP (total_height))
24937 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24938 else
24940 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24941 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24943 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24945 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24946 if (!NILP (total_height))
24947 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24951 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24953 if (font->space_width > 0)
24955 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24956 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24957 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24959 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24960 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24961 tab stop after that. */
24962 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24963 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24965 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24966 it->nglyphs = 1;
24967 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24968 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24970 if (it->glyph_row)
24972 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24973 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24976 else
24978 it->pixel_width = 0;
24979 it->nglyphs = 1;
24983 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24985 /* A static composition.
24987 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24988 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24990 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24991 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24992 the overall glyphs composed). */
24993 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24994 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24995 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24996 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24997 struct font *font = face->font;
24999 it->nglyphs = 1;
25001 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
25002 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
25003 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
25004 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
25005 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
25006 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
25007 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
25008 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
25010 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
25011 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
25012 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
25013 than these, respectively. */
25014 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
25015 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25016 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
25017 int lbearing, rbearing;
25018 int i, width, ascent, descent;
25019 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
25020 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
25021 XChar2b char2b;
25022 struct font_metrics *pcm;
25023 int font_not_found_p;
25024 ptrdiff_t pos;
25026 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
25027 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
25028 break;
25029 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
25030 right_padded = 1;
25031 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
25033 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
25034 break;
25035 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25037 if (i > 0)
25038 left_padded = 1;
25040 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
25041 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
25042 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
25043 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
25044 if (font_not_found_p)
25046 face = face->ascii_face;
25047 font = face->font;
25049 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25050 if (font->vertical_centering)
25051 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25052 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25053 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25054 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
25056 cmp->font = font;
25058 pcm = NULL;
25059 if (! font_not_found_p)
25061 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25062 &char2b, 0);
25063 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25066 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25067 if (pcm)
25069 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25070 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25071 descent = pcm->descent;
25072 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25073 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25075 else
25077 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25078 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25079 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25080 lbearing = 0;
25081 rbearing = width;
25084 rightmost = width;
25085 leftmost = 0;
25086 lowest = - descent + boff;
25087 highest = ascent + boff;
25089 if (! font_not_found_p
25090 && font->default_ascent
25091 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25092 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25093 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25094 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25096 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25097 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25098 at the left. */
25099 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25100 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25101 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25102 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25104 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25105 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25107 int left, right, btm, top;
25108 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25109 int face_id;
25110 struct face *this_face;
25112 if (ch == '\t')
25113 ch = ' ';
25114 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25115 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25116 font = this_face->font;
25118 if (font == NULL)
25119 pcm = NULL;
25120 else
25122 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25123 &char2b, 0);
25124 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25126 if (! pcm)
25127 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25128 else
25130 width = pcm->width;
25131 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25132 descent = pcm->descent;
25133 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25134 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25135 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25137 /* Relative composition with or without
25138 alternate chars. */
25139 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25140 btm = - descent + boff;
25141 if (font->relative_compose
25142 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25143 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25144 make_number (ch)))))
25147 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25148 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25149 btm = highest + 1;
25150 else if (ascent <= 0)
25151 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25152 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25155 else
25157 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25158 value that encodes global and new reference
25159 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25160 specified by numbers as below:
25162 0---1---2 -- ascent
25166 9--10--11 -- center
25168 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25170 6---7---8 -- descent
25172 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25173 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25175 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25176 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25177 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25178 if (xoff)
25179 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25180 if (yoff)
25181 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25183 left = (leftmost
25184 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25185 - nrefx * width / 2
25186 + xoff);
25188 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25189 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25190 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25191 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25192 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25193 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25194 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25195 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25196 + yoff);
25199 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25200 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25202 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25203 if (width > 0)
25205 right = left + width;
25206 if (left < leftmost)
25207 leftmost = left;
25208 if (right > rightmost)
25209 rightmost = right;
25211 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25212 if (top > highest)
25213 highest = top;
25214 if (btm < lowest)
25215 lowest = btm;
25217 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25218 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25219 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25220 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25224 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25225 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25226 non-negative. */
25227 if (leftmost < 0)
25229 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25230 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25231 rightmost -= leftmost;
25232 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25233 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25236 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25238 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25239 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25240 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25241 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25242 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25244 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25246 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25249 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25250 cmp->ascent = highest;
25251 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25252 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25253 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25254 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25255 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25258 if (it->glyph_row
25259 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25260 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25261 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25263 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25264 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25265 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25266 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25268 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25270 if (thick > 0)
25272 it->ascent += thick;
25273 it->descent += thick;
25275 else
25276 thick = - thick;
25278 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25279 it->pixel_width += thick;
25280 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25281 it->pixel_width += thick;
25284 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25285 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25286 if (face->overline_p)
25287 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25289 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25290 if (it->ascent < 0)
25291 it->ascent = 0;
25292 if (it->descent < 0)
25293 it->descent = 0;
25295 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25296 append_composite_glyph (it);
25298 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25300 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25301 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25302 Lisp_Object gstring;
25303 struct font_metrics metrics;
25305 it->nglyphs = 1;
25307 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25308 it->pixel_width
25309 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25310 &metrics);
25311 if (it->glyph_row
25312 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25313 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25314 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25315 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25316 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25318 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25320 if (thick > 0)
25322 it->ascent += thick;
25323 it->descent += thick;
25325 else
25326 thick = - thick;
25328 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25329 it->pixel_width += thick;
25330 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25331 it->pixel_width += thick;
25333 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25334 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25335 if (face->overline_p)
25336 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25337 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25338 if (it->ascent < 0)
25339 it->ascent = 0;
25340 if (it->descent < 0)
25341 it->descent = 0;
25343 if (it->glyph_row)
25344 append_composite_glyph (it);
25346 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
25347 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
25348 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
25349 produce_image_glyph (it);
25350 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
25351 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
25353 done:
25354 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
25355 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
25356 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
25357 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
25358 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
25360 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
25362 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
25363 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
25364 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
25367 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
25368 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
25369 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
25370 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
25373 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25374 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
25375 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
25376 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
25377 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
25378 row being updated. */
25380 void
25381 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25383 int x, hpos, chpos = updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos;
25385 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25386 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25387 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25388 margin in that case. */
25389 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
25390 chpos = 0;
25391 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25392 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25394 block_input ();
25396 /* Write glyphs. */
25398 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
25399 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
25400 updated_row, updated_area,
25401 hpos, hpos + len,
25402 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25404 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
25405 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
25406 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
25407 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
25408 && chpos >= hpos
25409 && chpos < hpos + len)
25410 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25412 unblock_input ();
25414 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25415 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25416 output_cursor.x = x;
25420 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25421 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
25423 void
25424 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25426 struct frame *f;
25427 struct window *w;
25428 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
25429 struct glyph_row *row;
25430 struct glyph *glyph;
25431 int frame_x, frame_y;
25432 ptrdiff_t hpos;
25434 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25435 block_input ();
25436 w = updated_window;
25437 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25439 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
25440 row = updated_row;
25441 line_height = row->height;
25443 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
25444 shift_by_width = 0;
25445 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
25446 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
25448 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
25449 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
25450 - output_cursor.x
25451 - shift_by_width);
25453 /* Shift right. */
25454 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
25455 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
25457 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
25458 line_height, shift_by_width);
25460 /* Write the glyphs. */
25461 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
25462 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
25463 hpos, hpos + len,
25464 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25466 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25467 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25468 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
25469 unblock_input ();
25473 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25474 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
25475 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
25476 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
25478 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
25479 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
25481 void
25482 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
25484 struct frame *f;
25485 struct window *w = updated_window;
25486 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
25487 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
25489 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25490 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25492 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25493 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
25494 else
25495 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
25496 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25498 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
25499 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
25500 if (to_x == 0)
25501 return;
25502 else if (to_x < 0)
25503 to_x = max_x;
25504 else
25505 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
25507 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
25509 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
25510 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
25511 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
25512 output_cursor.x, -1,
25513 updated_row->y,
25514 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
25516 from_x = output_cursor.x;
25518 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
25519 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25521 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
25522 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
25524 else
25526 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
25527 from_x += area_left;
25528 to_x += area_left;
25531 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25532 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
25533 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
25535 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
25536 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
25538 block_input ();
25539 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
25540 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
25541 unblock_input ();
25545 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25549 /***********************************************************************
25550 Cursor types
25551 ***********************************************************************/
25553 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
25554 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
25555 of the bar cursor. */
25557 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25558 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
25560 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
25562 if (NILP (arg))
25563 return NO_CURSOR;
25565 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
25566 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
25568 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
25569 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25571 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
25573 *width = 2;
25574 return BAR_CURSOR;
25577 if (CONSP (arg)
25578 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
25579 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25581 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25582 return BAR_CURSOR;
25585 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
25587 *width = 2;
25588 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25591 if (CONSP (arg)
25592 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
25593 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25595 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25596 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25599 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
25600 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
25601 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
25602 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25604 return type;
25607 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
25608 void
25609 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
25611 int width = 1;
25612 Lisp_Object tem;
25614 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
25615 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25617 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
25619 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
25620 if (!NILP (tem))
25622 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
25623 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
25624 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25626 else
25627 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25631 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25633 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
25634 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
25635 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
25636 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
25638 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
25639 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
25640 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
25641 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
25642 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
25644 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25645 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
25646 int *active_cursor)
25648 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25649 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
25650 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25651 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
25652 int non_selected = 0;
25654 *active_cursor = 1;
25656 /* Echo area */
25657 if (cursor_in_echo_area
25658 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
25659 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
25661 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
25663 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25665 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25666 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25668 else
25669 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25672 *active_cursor = 0;
25673 non_selected = 1;
25676 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
25677 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
25678 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
25680 *active_cursor = 0;
25682 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
25683 return NO_CURSOR;
25685 non_selected = 1;
25688 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
25689 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25690 return NO_CURSOR;
25692 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
25693 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
25695 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25696 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25698 else
25699 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25701 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
25702 for non-selected window or frame. */
25703 if (non_selected)
25705 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
25706 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
25707 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
25708 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
25709 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25710 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25711 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
25712 --*width;
25713 return cursor_type;
25716 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
25717 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
25719 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
25721 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25723 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
25724 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
25725 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
25726 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
25727 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
25729 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
25730 where N = size of default frame font size.
25731 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
25732 if (!img->mask
25733 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
25734 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
25735 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25738 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
25740 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
25741 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
25742 not a solid box cursor. */
25743 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25746 return cursor_type;
25749 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
25751 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
25752 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
25753 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
25755 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
25756 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
25758 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25759 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25762 #if 0
25763 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25764 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25765 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25767 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25768 filled box <-> hollow box
25769 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25770 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25771 other type <-> no cursor */
25773 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25774 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25776 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25778 *width = 1;
25779 return cursor_type;
25781 #endif
25783 return NO_CURSOR;
25787 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25788 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25789 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25790 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25791 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25792 are window-relative. */
25794 static void
25795 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25796 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25798 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25799 struct glyph_row *row;
25801 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25802 return;
25803 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25804 return;
25806 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25807 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25808 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25809 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25810 return;
25812 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25814 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25815 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25816 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25817 return;
25820 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25821 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25822 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25823 return;
25825 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25826 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25827 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25828 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25829 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25830 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25831 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25832 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25833 over the cursor image.
25835 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25836 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25837 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25838 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25839 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25841 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25842 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25843 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25844 return;
25846 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25849 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25852 /************************************************************************
25853 Mouse Face
25854 ************************************************************************/
25856 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25858 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25859 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25860 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25862 void
25863 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25864 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25866 int i, x;
25868 block_input ();
25870 x = 0;
25871 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25873 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25875 int start = i, start_x = x;
25879 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25880 ++i;
25882 while (i < row->used[area]
25883 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25885 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25886 start, i,
25887 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25889 else
25891 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25892 ++i;
25896 unblock_input ();
25900 /* EXPORT:
25901 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25902 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25904 void
25905 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25906 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25908 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25909 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25910 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25911 if ((row->reversed_p
25912 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25913 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25915 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25916 int x1;
25917 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25919 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
25920 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
25921 window margin in that case. */
25922 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25923 hpos = 0;
25924 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25925 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25927 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
25928 hl, 0);
25929 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25931 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25932 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25933 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25934 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25935 are redrawn. */
25936 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25938 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25940 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25941 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25942 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25943 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25945 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25946 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25947 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25948 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25954 /* EXPORT:
25955 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25957 void
25958 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25960 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25961 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25962 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25963 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25964 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25965 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25966 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25967 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25968 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25970 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25971 screen. */
25972 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25973 goto mark_cursor_off;
25975 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25976 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25977 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25978 goto mark_cursor_off;
25980 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25981 can do. */
25982 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25983 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25984 goto mark_cursor_off;
25986 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25987 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25988 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25989 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25991 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25992 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25993 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25994 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25995 goto mark_cursor_off;
25997 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25998 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
26000 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
26001 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
26002 goto mark_cursor_off;
26005 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
26006 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
26007 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
26008 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
26009 cursor glyph at hand. */
26010 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
26011 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
26012 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
26013 goto mark_cursor_off;
26015 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26016 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26017 margin in that case. */
26018 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26019 hpos = 0;
26020 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26021 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26023 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
26024 we clear the cursor. */
26025 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26026 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
26027 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
26028 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
26029 mouse highlighting does not. */
26030 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
26031 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
26033 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
26034 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
26036 int x, y, left_x;
26037 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
26038 int width;
26040 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
26041 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
26042 goto mark_cursor_off;
26044 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
26045 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
26046 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
26047 if (x < left_x)
26048 width -= left_x - x;
26049 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
26050 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
26051 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
26053 if (width > 0)
26054 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
26057 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26058 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26059 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26060 else
26061 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26062 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26064 mark_cursor_off:
26065 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26066 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26070 /* EXPORT:
26071 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26072 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26073 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26075 void
26076 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
26077 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26079 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26080 int new_cursor_type;
26081 int new_cursor_width;
26082 int active_cursor;
26083 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26084 struct glyph *glyph;
26086 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26087 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26088 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26089 window. */
26090 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26091 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26092 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26093 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26094 return;
26096 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26097 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26098 return;
26100 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26101 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26102 display the cursor. */
26103 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26105 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26106 return;
26109 glyph = NULL;
26110 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26111 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26112 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26114 eassert (input_blocked_p ());
26116 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26117 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26118 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26120 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26121 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26122 erase it. */
26123 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26124 && (!on
26125 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26126 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26127 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26128 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26129 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26130 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26132 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26133 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26134 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26135 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26136 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26137 if (on)
26139 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26140 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26142 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26143 of them may need the information. */
26144 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26145 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26146 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26147 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26150 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26151 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26152 on, active_cursor);
26156 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26157 of ON. */
26159 static void
26160 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
26162 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26163 of being deleted. */
26164 if (w->current_matrix)
26166 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26167 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26168 struct glyph_row *row;
26170 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26171 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26172 return;
26174 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26176 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26177 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26178 window margin in that case. */
26179 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26180 hpos = 0;
26181 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26182 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26184 block_input ();
26185 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26186 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26187 unblock_input ();
26192 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26193 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26195 static void
26196 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
26198 while (w)
26200 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
26201 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
26202 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
26203 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
26204 else
26205 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26207 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26212 /* EXPORT:
26213 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26214 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26216 void
26217 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
26219 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26223 /* EXPORT:
26224 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26225 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26226 is about to be rewritten. */
26228 void
26229 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26231 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26232 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26235 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26237 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26238 and MSDOS. */
26239 static void
26240 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26241 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26242 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26244 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26245 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26247 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26248 return;
26250 #endif
26251 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26252 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26253 #endif
26256 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26258 static void
26259 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26261 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26262 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26264 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26265 to do anything. */
26266 w->current_matrix != NULL
26267 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26268 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26269 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26270 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26271 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26273 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26274 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26276 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26277 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26279 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26281 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26283 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26284 if (row == first)
26286 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26287 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26288 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26289 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26290 if (!row->reversed_p)
26292 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26293 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26295 else if (row == last)
26297 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26298 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26300 else
26302 start_hpos = 0;
26303 start_x = 0;
26306 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26308 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26309 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26311 else
26313 start_hpos = 0;
26314 start_x = 0;
26317 if (row == last)
26319 if (!row->reversed_p)
26320 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26321 else if (row == first)
26322 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26323 else
26325 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26326 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26327 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26330 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
26331 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26332 else
26334 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26335 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26336 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26339 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
26341 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
26342 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26344 row->mouse_face_p
26345 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
26349 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26350 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
26351 be displayed again. */
26352 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
26353 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26355 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26357 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26358 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26359 window margin in that case. */
26360 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26361 hpos = 0;
26362 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26363 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26365 block_input ();
26366 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26367 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26368 unblock_input ();
26370 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26373 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26374 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
26375 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26377 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
26378 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
26379 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
26380 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
26381 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
26382 else
26383 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
26385 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26388 /* EXPORT:
26389 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
26390 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
26391 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
26394 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
26396 int cleared = 0;
26398 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
26400 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
26401 cleared = 1;
26404 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
26405 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
26406 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
26407 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
26408 return cleared;
26411 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
26412 within the mouse face on that window. */
26413 static int
26414 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
26416 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
26418 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
26419 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26420 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
26421 return 0;
26422 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26423 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26424 return 0;
26425 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26426 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26427 return 1;
26429 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
26431 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26433 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26434 return 1;
26436 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26437 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26438 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26439 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26440 return 1;
26442 else
26444 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26446 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26447 return 1;
26449 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26450 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26451 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26452 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26453 return 1;
26455 return 0;
26459 /* EXPORT:
26460 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
26463 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
26465 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26466 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26467 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26469 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26470 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26471 margin in that case. */
26472 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26473 hpos = 0;
26474 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26475 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26477 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
26482 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
26483 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
26484 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
26485 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
26486 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
26487 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
26488 static void
26489 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
26490 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26491 Lisp_Object disp_string,
26492 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
26494 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26495 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26496 struct glyph_row *row;
26498 *start = NULL;
26499 *end = NULL;
26501 while (!first->enabled_p
26502 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
26503 first++;
26505 /* Find the START row. */
26506 for (row = first;
26507 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
26508 row++)
26510 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
26511 characters it displays intersects the range
26512 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
26513 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
26514 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
26515 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
26516 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
26517 some position is beyond the end of the characters
26518 displayed by a row. */
26519 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26520 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26521 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26522 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
26523 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26524 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26525 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26526 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
26528 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
26529 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
26530 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
26532 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
26533 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
26534 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
26535 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
26536 the range of character positions given by the row's start
26537 and end positions. */
26538 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26539 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26541 while (g < e)
26543 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26544 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26545 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26546 definition to be highlighted. */
26547 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26548 *start = row;
26549 g++;
26551 if (*start)
26552 break;
26556 /* Find the END row. */
26557 if (!*start
26558 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
26559 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
26560 && !(row->enabled_p
26561 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
26562 row = first;
26563 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
26565 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
26566 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
26568 if (!next->enabled_p
26569 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
26570 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
26571 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
26572 is the row END + 1. */
26573 || (start_charpos < next_start
26574 && end_charpos < next_start)
26575 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26576 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26577 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26578 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
26579 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26580 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26581 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26582 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
26584 *end = row;
26585 break;
26587 else
26589 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
26590 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
26591 also END + 1. */
26592 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26593 struct glyph *s = g;
26594 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
26596 while (g < e)
26598 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26599 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26600 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
26601 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
26602 the last character to be highlighted is the
26603 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
26604 END, not END+1. */
26605 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
26606 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
26607 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
26608 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
26609 empty line at ZV. */
26610 || (g->charpos == -1
26611 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26612 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
26613 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26614 definition to be highlighted. */
26615 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26616 break;
26617 g++;
26619 if (g == e)
26621 *end = row;
26622 break;
26624 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
26625 highlighted. */
26626 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
26628 *end = next;
26629 break;
26635 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
26636 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
26637 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
26638 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
26639 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
26640 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
26641 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
26642 or all of the highlighted text. */
26644 static void
26645 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
26646 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26647 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
26648 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
26649 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26650 Lisp_Object before_string,
26651 Lisp_Object after_string,
26652 Lisp_Object disp_string)
26654 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26655 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26656 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
26657 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
26658 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
26659 int x;
26661 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
26662 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
26663 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
26665 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26666 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
26667 if (r1 == NULL)
26668 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26669 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
26670 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
26671 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
26673 struct glyph_row *prev;
26674 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
26675 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
26676 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
26678 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26679 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
26680 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
26681 if (glyph < beg
26682 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
26683 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
26684 break;
26685 r1 = prev;
26688 if (r2 == NULL)
26690 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26691 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
26693 else if (!NILP (after_string))
26695 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
26696 struct glyph_row *next;
26697 struct glyph_row *last
26698 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26700 for (next = r2 + 1;
26701 next <= last
26702 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
26703 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
26704 ++next)
26705 r2 = next;
26707 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
26708 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
26709 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
26710 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
26711 them in correct order. */
26712 if (r1->y > r2->y)
26714 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
26716 r2 = r1;
26717 r1 = tem;
26720 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
26721 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
26722 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
26723 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
26725 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
26726 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
26727 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
26728 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
26729 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
26730 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
26731 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
26732 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
26733 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
26734 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
26735 if (!r1->reversed_p)
26737 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
26738 right. */
26739 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26740 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26741 x = r1->x;
26743 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26744 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26745 for (; glyph < end
26746 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26747 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26748 ++glyph)
26749 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26751 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26752 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26753 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26754 for (; glyph < end
26755 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26756 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26757 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26758 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26759 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26760 ++glyph)
26762 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26763 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26764 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26765 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26767 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
26768 start_charpos);
26769 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26770 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26771 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26772 break;
26774 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26776 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26777 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26778 break;
26780 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26782 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26783 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26785 else
26787 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
26788 left. */
26789 struct glyph *g;
26791 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26792 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26794 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26795 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26796 for (; glyph > end
26797 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26798 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26799 --glyph)
26802 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26803 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26804 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26805 for (; glyph > end
26806 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26807 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26808 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26809 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26810 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26811 --glyph)
26813 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26814 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26815 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26816 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26818 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26819 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26820 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26821 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26822 break;
26824 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26826 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26827 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26828 break;
26832 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
26833 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
26834 x += g->pixel_width;
26835 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26836 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26839 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
26840 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
26841 the row where the highlight begins. */
26842 if (r2 != r1)
26844 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26846 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26847 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26848 x = r2->x;
26850 else
26852 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26853 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26857 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26859 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26860 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26861 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26862 while (end > glyph
26863 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
26864 --end;
26865 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26866 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26867 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26868 and END_CHARPOS */
26869 for (--end;
26870 end > glyph
26871 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26872 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26873 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26874 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26875 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26876 --end)
26878 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26879 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26880 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26881 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26883 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26884 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26885 break;
26887 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26889 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26890 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26891 break;
26894 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26895 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26896 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26898 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26899 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26901 else
26903 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26904 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26905 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26906 x = r2->x;
26907 end++;
26908 while (end < glyph
26909 && INTEGERP (end->object))
26911 x += end->pixel_width;
26912 ++end;
26914 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26915 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26916 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26917 and END_CHARPOS */
26918 for ( ;
26919 end < glyph
26920 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26921 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26922 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26923 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26924 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26925 ++end)
26927 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26928 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26929 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26930 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26932 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26933 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26934 break;
26936 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26938 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26939 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26940 break;
26942 x += end->pixel_width;
26944 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
26945 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
26946 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
26947 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
26948 last glyph. */
26949 if (end == glyph
26950 && BUFFERP (end->object)
26951 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
26952 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
26954 x += end->pixel_width;
26955 ++end;
26957 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26958 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26961 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26962 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26963 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26964 mouse_charpos + 1,
26965 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26966 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26969 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26970 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26971 being, in case someone would. */
26973 #if 0 /* not used */
26975 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26976 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26977 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26979 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26980 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26982 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26983 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26984 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26985 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26986 next larger position in OBJECT.
26988 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26990 static int
26991 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
26992 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26994 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26995 struct glyph_row *r;
26996 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26997 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26998 int best_x = 0;
27000 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27001 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27002 ++r)
27004 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27005 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27006 int gx;
27008 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27009 if (EQ (g->object, object))
27011 if (g->charpos == pos)
27013 best_glyph = g;
27014 best_x = gx;
27015 best_row = r;
27016 goto found;
27018 else if (best_glyph == NULL
27019 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
27020 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
27021 && (right_p
27022 ? g->charpos < pos
27023 : g->charpos > pos)))
27025 best_glyph = g;
27026 best_x = gx;
27027 best_row = r;
27032 found:
27034 if (best_glyph)
27036 *x = best_x;
27037 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27039 if (right_p)
27041 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
27042 ++*hpos;
27045 *y = best_row->y;
27046 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
27049 return best_glyph != NULL;
27051 #endif /* not used */
27053 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
27054 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
27055 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
27056 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
27058 static void
27059 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27060 Lisp_Object object,
27061 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27063 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27064 struct glyph_row *r;
27065 struct glyph *g, *e;
27066 int gx;
27067 int found = 0;
27069 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27070 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
27071 position belongs to that range. */
27072 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27073 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27074 ++r)
27076 if (!r->reversed_p)
27078 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27079 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27080 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27081 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27082 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27084 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27085 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27086 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27087 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27088 found = 1;
27089 break;
27092 else
27094 struct glyph *g1;
27096 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27097 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27098 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27099 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27100 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27102 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27103 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27104 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27105 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27106 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27107 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27108 found = 1;
27109 break;
27112 if (found)
27113 break;
27116 if (!found)
27117 return;
27119 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27120 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27121 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27123 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27124 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27125 found = 0;
27126 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27127 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27128 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27130 found = 1;
27131 break;
27133 if (!found)
27134 break;
27137 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27138 r--;
27140 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
27141 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27142 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
27144 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27145 pixel coordinate. */
27146 if (!r->reversed_p)
27148 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27149 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27150 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27151 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27152 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27153 break;
27154 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27156 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27157 gx += g->pixel_width;
27158 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27160 else
27162 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27163 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27164 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27166 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27167 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
27168 break;
27169 gx += e->pixel_width;
27171 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27172 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27176 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27178 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27180 static int
27181 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27183 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27184 return 0;
27186 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27188 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27189 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27190 Lisp_Object tem;
27191 if (!CONSP (rect))
27192 return 0;
27193 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27194 return 0;
27195 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27196 return 0;
27197 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27198 return 0;
27199 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27200 return 0;
27201 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27202 return 0;
27203 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27204 return 0;
27205 return 1;
27207 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27209 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27210 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27211 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27212 if (CONSP (circ)
27213 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27214 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27215 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27216 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27218 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27219 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27220 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27221 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27224 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27226 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27227 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27229 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27230 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27231 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27232 ptrdiff_t i;
27233 int inside = 0;
27234 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27235 int x0, y0;
27237 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27238 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27239 return 0;
27241 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27242 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27243 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27244 polygon. */
27245 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27246 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27247 return 0;
27248 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27249 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27251 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27252 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27253 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27254 return 0;
27255 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27257 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27258 if (x0 >= x)
27260 if (x1 >= x)
27261 continue;
27263 else if (x1 < x)
27264 continue;
27265 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27266 continue;
27267 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27268 inside = !inside;
27270 return inside;
27273 return 0;
27276 Lisp_Object
27277 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27279 while (CONSP (map))
27281 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27282 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27283 return XCAR (map);
27284 map = XCDR (map);
27287 return Qnil;
27290 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27291 3, 3, 0,
27292 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27293 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27294 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27295 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27296 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27297 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27298 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27299 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27300 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27301 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27302 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27304 if (NILP (map))
27305 return Qnil;
27307 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27308 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27310 return find_hot_spot (map,
27311 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27312 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27316 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27317 static void
27318 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27320 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27321 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27322 return;
27324 if (!NILP (pointer))
27326 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
27327 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27328 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
27329 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
27330 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
27331 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27332 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
27333 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27334 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27335 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
27336 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27337 #endif
27338 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
27339 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
27340 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
27341 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
27342 else
27343 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27346 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
27347 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
27350 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27352 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
27353 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
27354 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
27355 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
27356 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
27358 static void
27359 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
27360 enum window_part area)
27362 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27363 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27364 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27365 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27366 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
27367 #endif
27368 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27369 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
27370 int dx, dy, width, height;
27371 ptrdiff_t charpos;
27372 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
27373 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
27375 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
27376 int original_x_pixel = x;
27377 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
27378 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
27380 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
27382 int x0;
27383 struct glyph *end;
27385 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27386 returns them in row/column units! */
27387 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27388 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27390 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27391 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
27392 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
27394 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
27395 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
27397 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27398 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27400 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
27401 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
27402 ++glyph)
27403 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
27405 if (glyph >= end)
27406 glyph = NULL;
27409 else
27411 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
27412 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27413 returns them in row/column units! */
27414 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27415 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27418 help = Qnil;
27420 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27421 if (IMAGEP (object))
27423 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27424 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
27425 !NILP (image_map))
27426 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
27427 CONSP (hotspot))
27428 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27430 Lisp_Object plist;
27432 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
27433 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27434 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27435 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27436 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27437 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27439 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27440 if (NILP (pointer))
27441 pointer = Qhand;
27442 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27443 if (!NILP (help))
27445 help_echo_string = help;
27446 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27447 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
27448 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27452 if (NILP (pointer))
27453 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
27455 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27457 if (STRINGP (string))
27458 pos = make_number (charpos);
27460 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
27461 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
27462 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
27463 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27465 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
27466 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
27467 if (NILP (help))
27469 if (STRINGP (string))
27470 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
27472 if (!NILP (help))
27474 help_echo_string = help;
27475 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27476 help_echo_object = string;
27477 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27479 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27481 Lisp_Object default_help
27482 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
27483 w->buffer);
27485 if (STRINGP (default_help))
27487 help_echo_string = default_help;
27488 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27489 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27490 help_echo_pos = -1;
27495 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27496 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
27497 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27499 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
27500 if (STRINGP (string))
27502 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27504 if (NILP (pointer))
27505 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
27507 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
27508 if (NILP (pointer)
27509 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
27511 Lisp_Object map;
27512 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
27513 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27514 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
27515 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27516 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27519 else
27520 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
27521 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27523 #endif
27526 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
27527 if (STRINGP (string))
27529 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
27530 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
27531 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27532 && glyph)
27534 Lisp_Object b, e;
27536 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
27538 int gpos;
27539 int gseq_length;
27540 int total_pixel_width;
27541 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
27543 int vpos, hpos;
27545 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
27546 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27547 if (NILP (b))
27548 begpos = 0;
27549 else
27550 begpos = XINT (b);
27552 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27553 if (NILP (e))
27554 endpos = SCHARS (string);
27555 else
27556 endpos = XINT (e);
27558 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
27559 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
27560 highlighted part of the string.
27562 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
27563 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
27564 line string format has structures which are converted to
27565 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
27566 internal string is an element of those structures. The
27567 displayed string is the flattened string. */
27568 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
27569 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
27570 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27571 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27572 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
27573 tmp_glyph++;
27574 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
27576 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
27577 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
27578 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
27579 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
27580 the internal string. */
27581 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27582 tmp_glyph > glyph
27583 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27584 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27585 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
27586 tmp_glyph--)
27588 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
27590 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
27591 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
27592 total_pixel_width = 0;
27593 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
27594 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
27596 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
27597 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
27598 marginal_area_string. */
27599 hpos = x - gpos;
27600 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27601 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
27602 : 0);
27604 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
27605 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
27606 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27607 && (!row->reversed_p
27608 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
27609 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27610 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
27611 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
27612 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
27613 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
27614 return;
27616 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27617 cursor = No_Cursor;
27619 if (!row->reversed_p)
27621 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
27622 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
27623 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27624 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27625 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
27627 else
27629 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
27630 coordinates to be swapped. */
27631 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
27632 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
27633 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27634 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27635 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
27638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
27639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
27640 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
27641 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
27642 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27643 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27645 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
27646 charpos,
27647 0, 0, 0,
27648 &ignore,
27649 glyph->face_id,
27651 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27653 if (NILP (pointer))
27654 pointer = Qhand;
27656 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27657 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27659 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27660 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27661 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27662 #endif
27666 /* EXPORT:
27667 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
27668 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
27669 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
27670 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
27672 void
27673 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
27675 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27676 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
27677 Lisp_Object window;
27678 struct window *w;
27679 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27680 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
27681 struct buffer *b;
27683 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
27684 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
27685 if (popup_activated ())
27686 return;
27687 #endif
27689 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
27690 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
27691 || f->pointer_invisible)
27692 return;
27694 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
27695 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
27696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
27698 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
27699 return;
27701 if (gc_in_progress)
27703 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
27704 return;
27707 /* Which window is that in? */
27708 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
27710 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
27711 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27712 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
27713 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27714 && !NILP (window)
27715 && part != ON_TEXT
27716 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
27717 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
27718 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27720 /* Not on a window -> return. */
27721 if (!WINDOWP (window))
27722 return;
27724 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
27725 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27727 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
27728 w = XWINDOW (window);
27729 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
27731 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27732 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
27733 buffer. */
27734 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
27736 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
27737 return;
27739 #endif
27741 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
27742 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
27743 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
27745 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
27746 return;
27749 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27750 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
27752 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27753 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
27755 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
27756 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
27757 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27758 else
27759 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27760 #endif
27762 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
27763 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
27764 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
27765 if (part == ON_TEXT
27766 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
27767 && w->last_modified == BUF_MODIFF (b)
27768 && w->last_overlay_modified == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
27770 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
27771 ptrdiff_t pos;
27772 struct glyph *glyph;
27773 Lisp_Object object;
27774 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
27775 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
27776 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
27777 struct buffer *obuf;
27778 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
27779 int same_region;
27781 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
27782 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
27784 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27785 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
27786 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
27788 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
27789 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
27791 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27792 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
27793 !NILP (image_map))
27794 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
27795 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
27796 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
27797 CONSP (hotspot))
27798 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27800 Lisp_Object plist;
27802 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
27803 this hot-spot.
27804 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27805 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27806 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27807 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27808 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27810 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27811 if (NILP (pointer))
27812 pointer = Qhand;
27813 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27814 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
27816 help_echo_window = window;
27817 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
27818 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
27822 if (NILP (pointer))
27823 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
27826 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27828 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
27829 if (glyph == NULL
27830 || area != TEXT_AREA
27831 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
27832 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
27833 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
27834 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
27835 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
27836 glyph, we are not over any text. */
27837 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27838 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
27839 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
27840 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
27841 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
27842 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
27843 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
27844 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
27845 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
27847 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27848 cursor = No_Cursor;
27849 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27850 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27852 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
27853 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27854 else
27855 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
27857 #endif
27858 goto set_cursor;
27861 pos = glyph->charpos;
27862 object = glyph->object;
27863 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
27864 goto set_cursor;
27866 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
27867 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
27868 goto set_cursor;
27870 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
27871 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
27872 obuf = current_buffer;
27873 current_buffer = b;
27874 obegv = BEGV;
27875 ozv = ZV;
27876 BEGV = BEG;
27877 ZV = Z;
27879 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
27880 position = make_number (pos);
27882 if (BUFFERP (object))
27884 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
27885 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
27886 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
27887 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
27889 else
27890 noverlays = 0;
27892 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27894 if (same_region)
27895 cursor = No_Cursor;
27897 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27898 if (! same_region
27899 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27900 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27901 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27902 highlight only that. */
27903 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27904 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27906 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27907 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27908 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27910 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27911 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27912 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27915 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27916 no need to do that again. */
27917 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27918 goto check_help_echo;
27919 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27921 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27922 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27923 cursor = No_Cursor;
27925 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27926 if (NILP (overlay))
27927 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27929 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27930 display it. */
27931 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27933 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27934 with a mouse-face. */
27935 Lisp_Object s, e;
27936 ptrdiff_t ignore;
27938 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27939 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27940 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27941 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27942 if (NILP (s))
27943 s = make_number (0);
27944 if (NILP (e))
27945 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27946 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27947 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27948 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27949 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27950 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27951 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27952 glyph->face_id, 1);
27953 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27954 cursor = No_Cursor;
27956 else
27958 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27959 or text property in the buffer. */
27960 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27961 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27963 if (STRINGP (object))
27965 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27966 check if the text under it has one. */
27967 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27968 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27969 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27970 if (pos > 0)
27972 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27973 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27974 buffer = w->buffer;
27975 disp_string = object;
27978 else
27980 buffer = object;
27981 disp_string = Qnil;
27984 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27986 Lisp_Object before, after;
27987 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27988 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27989 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27990 optimization of limiting the search in
27991 previous-single-property-change and
27992 next-single-property-change, because
27993 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27994 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27995 the first row visible in a window does not
27996 necessarily display the character whose position
27997 is the smallest. */
27998 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27999 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
28000 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
28001 : Qnil;
28002 Lisp_Object lim2 =
28003 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
28004 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28005 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
28006 : Qnil;
28008 if (NILP (overlay))
28010 /* Handle the text property case. */
28011 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
28012 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
28013 after = Fnext_single_property_change
28014 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
28015 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
28017 else
28019 /* Handle the overlay case. */
28020 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
28021 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
28022 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
28023 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
28025 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
28026 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
28029 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
28030 NILP (before)
28032 : XFASTINT (before),
28033 NILP (after)
28034 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28035 : XFASTINT (after),
28036 before_string, after_string,
28037 disp_string);
28038 cursor = No_Cursor;
28043 check_help_echo:
28045 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
28046 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
28047 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
28049 /* Check overlays first. */
28050 help = overlay = Qnil;
28051 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
28053 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
28054 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
28057 if (!NILP (help))
28059 help_echo_string = help;
28060 help_echo_window = window;
28061 help_echo_object = overlay;
28062 help_echo_pos = pos;
28064 else
28066 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28067 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28069 /* Try text properties. */
28070 if (STRINGP (obj)
28071 && charpos >= 0
28072 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28074 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28075 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28076 if (NILP (help))
28078 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28079 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28080 struct glyph_row *r
28081 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28082 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28083 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28084 if (p > 0)
28086 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28087 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
28088 if (!NILP (help))
28090 charpos = p;
28091 obj = w->buffer;
28096 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28097 && charpos >= BEGV
28098 && charpos < ZV)
28099 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28100 obj);
28102 if (!NILP (help))
28104 help_echo_string = help;
28105 help_echo_window = window;
28106 help_echo_object = obj;
28107 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28112 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28113 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28114 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28116 /* Check overlays first. */
28117 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28118 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28120 if (NILP (pointer))
28122 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28123 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28125 /* Try text properties. */
28126 if (STRINGP (obj)
28127 && charpos >= 0
28128 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28130 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28131 Qpointer, obj);
28132 if (NILP (pointer))
28134 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28135 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28136 struct glyph_row *r
28137 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28138 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28139 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28140 if (p > 0)
28141 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28142 Qpointer, w->buffer);
28145 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28146 && charpos >= BEGV
28147 && charpos < ZV)
28148 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28149 Qpointer, obj);
28152 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28154 BEGV = obegv;
28155 ZV = ozv;
28156 current_buffer = obuf;
28159 set_cursor:
28161 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28162 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28163 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28164 #else
28165 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28166 compound statement". */
28167 return;
28168 #endif
28172 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28173 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28174 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28175 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28177 void
28178 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28180 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28181 Lisp_Object window;
28183 block_input ();
28184 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28185 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28186 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28187 unblock_input ();
28191 /* EXPORT:
28192 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28193 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28195 void
28196 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28198 Lisp_Object window;
28199 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28201 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28202 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28204 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
28205 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
28206 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
28212 /***********************************************************************
28213 Exposure Events
28214 ***********************************************************************/
28216 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28218 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28219 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28221 static void
28222 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28223 enum glyph_row_area area)
28225 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28226 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28227 struct glyph *last;
28228 int first_x, start_x, x;
28230 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28231 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28232 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28233 0, row->used[area],
28234 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28235 else
28237 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28238 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28239 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28240 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28241 x = start_x;
28242 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28243 x += row->x;
28245 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28246 while (first < end
28247 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28249 x += first->pixel_width;
28250 ++first;
28253 /* Find the last one. */
28254 last = first;
28255 first_x = x;
28256 while (last < end
28257 && x < r->x + r->width)
28259 x += last->pixel_width;
28260 ++last;
28263 /* Repaint. */
28264 if (last > first)
28265 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28266 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28267 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28272 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28273 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28274 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28276 static int
28277 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28279 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28281 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28282 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28283 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28284 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28285 else
28287 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28288 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28289 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28290 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28291 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28292 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28293 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28296 return row->mouse_face_p;
28300 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28301 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28302 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28304 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28305 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28306 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28308 static void
28309 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28310 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28311 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28312 XRectangle *r)
28314 struct glyph_row *row;
28316 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28317 if (row->overlapping_p)
28319 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
28321 row->clip = r;
28322 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28323 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28325 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28326 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28328 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28329 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28330 row->clip = NULL;
28335 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
28337 static int
28338 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28340 XRectangle cr, result;
28341 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
28342 struct glyph_row *row;
28344 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
28345 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
28346 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
28347 row->enabled_p)
28348 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
28350 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
28351 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
28352 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
28353 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
28354 : TEXT_AREA));
28355 cr.y = row->y;
28356 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
28357 cr.height = row->height;
28358 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28361 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
28362 if (cursor_glyph)
28364 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
28365 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
28366 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
28367 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
28368 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
28369 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
28370 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
28371 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
28372 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28374 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
28375 return 0;
28379 /* EXPORT:
28380 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
28381 have vertical scroll bars. */
28383 void
28384 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
28386 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
28388 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
28389 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
28390 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
28392 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
28393 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
28394 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
28395 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
28396 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
28397 return;
28399 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
28400 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
28402 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28404 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28405 y1 -= 1;
28407 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28408 x1 -= 1;
28410 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
28412 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
28413 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
28415 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28417 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28418 y1 -= 1;
28420 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28421 x0 -= 1;
28423 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
28428 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
28429 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
28430 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
28431 mouse-face. */
28433 static int
28434 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
28436 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28437 XRectangle wr, r;
28438 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28440 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
28441 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
28442 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
28443 created window. */
28444 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
28445 return 0;
28447 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
28448 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
28449 later. */
28450 if (w == updated_window)
28452 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
28453 return 0;
28456 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
28457 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28458 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28459 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
28460 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
28462 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
28464 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
28465 struct glyph_row *row;
28466 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
28467 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
28469 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
28470 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28472 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
28473 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28474 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28476 /* Turn off the cursor. */
28477 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
28478 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
28480 x_clear_cursor (w);
28481 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
28483 else
28484 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
28486 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
28487 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
28488 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
28489 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
28490 check later if it is changed. */
28491 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
28493 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
28494 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
28495 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
28496 row->enabled_p;
28497 ++row)
28499 int y0 = row->y;
28500 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
28502 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
28503 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
28504 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
28505 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
28507 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
28508 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
28509 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
28511 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28512 first_overlapping_row = row;
28513 last_overlapping_row = row;
28516 row->clip = fr;
28517 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28518 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28519 row->clip = NULL;
28521 else if (row->overlapping_p)
28523 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
28524 if (y0 < r.y
28525 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
28526 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
28528 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28529 first_overlapping_row = row;
28530 last_overlapping_row = row;
28534 if (y1 >= yb)
28535 break;
28538 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
28539 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
28540 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
28541 row->enabled_p)
28542 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
28544 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28545 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28548 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
28550 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
28551 if (first_overlapping_row)
28552 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
28553 fr);
28555 /* Draw border between windows. */
28556 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
28558 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
28559 if (cursor_cleared_p
28560 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
28561 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
28565 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28570 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
28571 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
28572 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
28574 static int
28575 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28577 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28578 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28580 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28582 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
28583 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28584 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
28585 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
28586 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28587 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
28588 else
28589 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
28591 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
28594 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28598 /* EXPORT:
28599 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
28600 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
28601 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
28602 the entire frame. */
28604 void
28605 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
28607 XRectangle r;
28608 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28610 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
28612 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
28613 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28615 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
28616 return;
28619 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
28620 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
28621 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
28622 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
28623 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
28625 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
28626 return;
28629 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
28631 r.x = r.y = 0;
28632 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
28633 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
28635 else
28637 r.x = x;
28638 r.y = y;
28639 r.width = w;
28640 r.height = h;
28643 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28644 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
28646 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
28647 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28648 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
28650 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28651 #ifndef MSDOS
28652 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
28653 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
28654 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28655 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
28656 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
28657 #endif
28658 #endif
28660 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
28661 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
28662 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
28663 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
28664 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
28665 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
28666 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
28667 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
28668 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
28669 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
28670 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
28671 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
28672 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
28673 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28675 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28676 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
28678 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
28679 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
28680 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28681 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
28687 /* EXPORT:
28688 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
28689 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
28690 empty. */
28693 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
28695 XRectangle *left, *right;
28696 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
28697 int intersection_p = 0;
28699 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
28700 if (r1->x < r2->x)
28701 left = r1, right = r2;
28702 else
28703 left = r2, right = r1;
28705 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
28706 otherwise there is no intersection. */
28707 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
28709 result->x = right->x;
28711 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
28712 the right ends of left and right. */
28713 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
28714 - result->x);
28716 /* Same game for Y. */
28717 if (r1->y < r2->y)
28718 upper = r1, lower = r2;
28719 else
28720 upper = r2, lower = r1;
28722 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
28723 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
28724 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
28726 result->y = lower->y;
28728 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
28729 ends of upper and lower. */
28730 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
28731 upper->y + upper->height)
28732 - result->y);
28733 intersection_p = 1;
28737 return intersection_p;
28740 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28743 /***********************************************************************
28744 Initialization
28745 ***********************************************************************/
28747 void
28748 syms_of_xdisp (void)
28750 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
28751 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
28753 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
28754 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
28756 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
28757 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_internal, "redisplay_internal (C function)");
28759 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
28760 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
28761 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
28762 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
28763 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
28764 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
28766 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28767 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
28768 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
28769 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
28770 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
28771 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
28772 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
28773 #endif
28774 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28775 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
28776 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
28777 #endif
28778 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
28779 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
28780 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
28782 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
28783 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
28784 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
28785 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
28786 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
28787 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
28788 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
28789 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
28790 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
28791 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
28792 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
28793 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
28794 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
28795 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
28796 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
28797 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
28798 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
28799 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
28800 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
28801 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
28802 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
28803 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
28804 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
28805 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
28806 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
28807 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
28808 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
28809 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
28810 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
28811 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
28812 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
28813 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
28814 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
28815 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
28816 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
28817 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
28818 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
28819 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
28820 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
28821 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
28822 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
28823 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
28824 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
28825 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
28826 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
28827 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
28828 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
28829 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
28830 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
28831 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
28832 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
28833 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
28834 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
28835 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
28836 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
28838 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
28839 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
28840 Qnil);
28841 staticpro (&list_of_error);
28843 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
28844 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
28845 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
28846 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
28848 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28849 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
28850 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
28852 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28853 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
28854 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
28856 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
28857 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
28859 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
28860 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
28861 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
28862 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
28863 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
28864 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
28865 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
28866 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
28867 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
28868 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
28870 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
28872 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28873 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
28874 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28875 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
28876 help_echo_window = Qnil;
28877 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
28878 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
28879 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
28880 help_echo_pos = -1;
28882 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
28883 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
28885 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28886 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
28887 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
28888 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
28889 wide as that tab on the display. */);
28890 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
28891 #endif
28893 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
28894 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
28895 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
28896 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
28898 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
28899 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
28900 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
28901 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
28902 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
28904 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
28905 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
28907 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
28908 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
28910 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
28911 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28913 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28914 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28915 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28916 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28917 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28919 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28920 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28921 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28922 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28924 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28925 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28926 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28928 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28929 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28930 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28931 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28932 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28934 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28935 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28936 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28937 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
28939 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28940 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28941 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28942 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28943 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28944 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28946 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28947 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28948 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28949 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28950 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28951 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28953 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28954 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28955 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28956 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28957 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28958 recenters point as usual.
28960 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28961 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28962 if you move far away.
28964 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28965 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28967 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28968 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28969 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28970 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28971 scroll_margin = 0;
28973 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28974 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28975 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28976 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28978 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28979 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28980 #endif
28982 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28983 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28984 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28985 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28986 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28987 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28989 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28990 not span the full frame width.
28992 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28994 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28995 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28997 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28998 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28999 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
29000 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
29001 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
29003 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
29004 line_number_display_limit_width,
29005 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
29006 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
29007 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
29008 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
29010 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
29011 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
29012 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
29014 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
29015 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
29016 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
29017 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
29018 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
29020 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
29021 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
29022 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29024 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
29025 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
29026 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29028 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
29029 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
29030 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29031 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
29032 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
29033 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29034 Vicon_title_format
29035 = Vframe_title_format
29036 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
29037 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
29038 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
29039 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
29040 empty_unibyte_string,
29041 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
29042 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
29043 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
29045 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
29046 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
29047 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
29048 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
29049 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (1000);
29051 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
29052 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29053 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29054 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29055 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29056 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29057 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29059 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29060 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29061 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29062 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29063 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29064 valid when these functions are called.
29066 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29067 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29068 work. */);
29069 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29071 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29072 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29073 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29074 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29076 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29077 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29078 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29079 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29080 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29082 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29083 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29084 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29085 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29086 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29087 window for the duration of the delay.
29088 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29089 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29090 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29091 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29092 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29093 mouse pointer enters it.
29095 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29096 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29098 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29099 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29100 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29102 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29103 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29104 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29105 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29106 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29107 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29108 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29110 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29111 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29112 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29114 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29115 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29116 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29118 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29119 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29120 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29121 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29122 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29123 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29124 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29126 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29127 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29128 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29129 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29130 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29131 vertical margin. */);
29132 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29134 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29135 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29136 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29138 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29139 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29140 It can be one of
29141 image - show images only
29142 text - show text only
29143 both - show both, text below image
29144 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29145 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29146 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29148 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29149 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29151 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29152 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29153 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29154 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29155 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29157 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29158 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29159 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29160 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29161 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29162 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29163 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29165 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29166 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29167 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29168 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29169 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29170 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29171 displayed according to the current fontset.
29173 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29174 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29175 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29177 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29178 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29179 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29180 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29181 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29183 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29184 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29185 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29186 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29187 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29188 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29189 echo area becomes empty. */);
29190 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29192 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29193 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29194 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29195 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29196 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29197 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29198 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29200 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29201 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29202 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29204 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29205 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29206 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29207 point visible. */);
29208 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29209 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29211 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29212 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29213 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29214 hscroll_margin = 5;
29216 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29217 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29218 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29219 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29220 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29221 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29222 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29223 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29224 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29226 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29227 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29228 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29230 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29231 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29232 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29234 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29235 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29236 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29237 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29239 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29240 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29241 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29242 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29243 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29244 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29246 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29247 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29248 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29249 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29251 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29252 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29253 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29255 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29256 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29257 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29258 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29260 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29261 property.
29263 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29264 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29265 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29266 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29268 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29269 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29270 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29271 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29273 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
29274 property.
29276 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
29277 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
29278 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
29279 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
29281 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
29282 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
29283 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
29285 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
29286 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
29287 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
29289 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29290 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
29291 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
29292 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
29294 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
29295 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
29296 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
29298 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
29299 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
29300 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
29301 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
29303 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
29304 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
29305 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
29306 margin to the character height. */);
29307 overline_margin = 2;
29309 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
29310 underline_minimum_offset,
29311 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
29312 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
29313 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
29314 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
29315 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
29316 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
29318 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
29319 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
29320 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
29321 cursor shapes. */);
29322 display_hourglass_p = 1;
29324 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
29325 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
29326 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
29328 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29329 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
29331 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
29332 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
29333 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
29334 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
29335 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
29337 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
29338 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
29339 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
29340 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
29341 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
29342 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
29344 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
29345 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
29346 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
29347 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
29348 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
29349 `empty-box': display as an empty box
29350 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
29351 `zero-width': don't display
29352 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
29353 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
29354 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
29356 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
29357 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
29358 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
29359 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
29360 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
29361 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
29362 Qempty_box);
29364 DEFVAR_LISP ("debug-on-message", Vdebug_on_message,
29365 doc: /* If non-nil, debug if a message matching this regexp is displayed. */);
29366 Vdebug_on_message = Qnil;
29370 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
29372 void
29373 init_xdisp (void)
29375 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
29377 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
29379 if (!noninteractive)
29381 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
29382 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
29383 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
29384 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
29385 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
29386 int i;
29388 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
29390 wset_top_line (r, make_number (FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29391 wset_total_lines
29392 (r, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29393 wset_total_cols (r, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29394 wset_top_line (m, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1));
29395 wset_total_lines (m, make_number (1));
29396 wset_total_cols (m, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29398 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
29399 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
29400 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
29402 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
29403 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
29404 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
29408 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
29409 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
29410 int size = 100;
29411 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
29412 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
29413 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
29414 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
29417 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
29420 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
29422 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
29423 void
29424 start_hourglass (void)
29426 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29427 EMACS_TIME delay;
29429 cancel_hourglass ();
29431 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
29432 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29433 delay = make_emacs_time (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
29434 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
29436 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
29437 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29438 delay = EMACS_TIME_FROM_DOUBLE (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
29439 else
29440 delay = make_emacs_time (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
29442 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
29444 extern void w32_note_current_window (void);
29445 w32_note_current_window ();
29447 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */
29449 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
29450 show_hourglass, NULL);
29451 #endif
29455 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
29456 shown. */
29457 void
29458 cancel_hourglass (void)
29460 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29461 if (hourglass_atimer)
29463 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
29464 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29467 if (hourglass_shown_p)
29468 hide_hourglass ();
29469 #endif